blob: a4841fc4d83ccfe6dc1998aaba6d67d0776902fb [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1753cb52019-11-03 15:43:10 +01007 2019/11/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200598 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200601 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200603 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100606 - presetenv
607 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - uid
609 - ulimit-n
610 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200611 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200613 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200615 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-options
617 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200618 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200619 - ssl-default-server-options
620 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100621 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100624 - 51degrees-data-file
625 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200626 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200627 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200628 - wurfl-data-file
629 - wurfl-information-list
630 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200631 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100632 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100635 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200636 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200638 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100639 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100640 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100641 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200642 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200643 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200644 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200645 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 - noepoll
647 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000648 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100650 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300651 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000652 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100653 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200654 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200655 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200656 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000657 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000658 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - tune.buffers.limit
660 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200661 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200662 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100663 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200664 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200665 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200666 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100667 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200668 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200669 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100670 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100671 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100672 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100673 - tune.lua.session-timeout
674 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200675 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100676 - tune.maxaccept
677 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200678 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200679 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200680 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100681 - tune.rcvbuf.client
682 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100683 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200684 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100685 - tune.sndbuf.client
686 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100687 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100688 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200689 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100690 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200691 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200692 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100693 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200694 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100695 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200696 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
697 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
698 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100699 - tune.zlib.memlevel
700 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100701
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702 * Debugging
703 - debug
704 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705
706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708------------------------------------
709
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200710ca-base <dir>
711 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200712 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
713 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715chroot <jail dir>
716 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
717 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
718 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
719 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
720 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100721 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100722
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100723cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
724 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
725 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
726 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
727 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
728 set. These sets have the format
729
730 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
731
732 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100733 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100734 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
735 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100736 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
737 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100738 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100739 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
743 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
744 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
745 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100746
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100747 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
748 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
749 on the machine's word size.
750
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
753 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
754 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
755 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
756 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
757 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758
759 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
761
762 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
763 # first 4 CPUs
764
765 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
766 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
767 # word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
772 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
773 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
774
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100775 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
776 # and so on.
777 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
778 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
779 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
780
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
783 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
784 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
785
786 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
788 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
789
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100790 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
791 # and a thread range.
792 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
793 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
794 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
795
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200796crt-base <dir>
797 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
798 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
799 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801daemon
802 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
803 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100804 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
805 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200806
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200807deviceatlas-json-file <path>
808 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100809 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200810
811deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100812 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200813 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
814
815deviceatlas-separator <char>
816 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
817 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
818
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100819deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200820 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
821 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
822 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100823
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900824external-check
825 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
826 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
827 See "option external-check".
828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200829gid <number>
830 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
831 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
832 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100833 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
834 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100836
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100837hard-stop-after <time>
838 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
839
840 Arguments :
841 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
842 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
843 SIGUSR1 signal.
844
845 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
846 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
847 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
848
849 Example:
850 global
851 hard-stop-after 30s
852
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200853h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
854 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
855 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
856 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
857 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
858 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
859 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
860 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
861 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
862 specified in a proxy.
863
864 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
865 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
866 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
867 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
868 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
869 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
870 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
871
872 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
873 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
874 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
875 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
876 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
877
878 Example:
879 global
880 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
881
882 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
883 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
884
885h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
886 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
887 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
888 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
889 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
890 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
891 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
892 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
893 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
894
895 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
896 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
897 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
898
899 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
900 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
901
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200902group <group name>
903 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
904 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100905
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200906log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
907 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100908 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100909 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100910 configured with "log global".
911
912 <address> can be one of:
913
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100914 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100915 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
916 port).
917
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100918 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
919 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
920 port).
921
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100922 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100923 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
924 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100925 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100926
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100927 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
928 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
929 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
930 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
931 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
932 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
933 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
934 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
935 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
936 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
937 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
938 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
939 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
940 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100941 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
942 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100943
944 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
945 "fd@2", see above.
946
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200947 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
948 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
949 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
950 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
951 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
952
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200953 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
954 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100955
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200956 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
957 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
958 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
959 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
960 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
961 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
962 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
963 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
964 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
965 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100966 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
967 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200968
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200969 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
970 one of the following :
971
972 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
973 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
974
975 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
976 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
977
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100978 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
979 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
980 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
981 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
982 logger consumes.
983
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100984 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
985 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
986 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
987 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
988
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200989 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
990 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
991 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
992 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
993 set with <sample_size> parameter.
994
995 <sample_size>
996 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
997 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
998 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
999 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1000 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1001
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001004 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1005 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1006 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1007
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001008 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1009 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1010 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1011 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001012
1013 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001014 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1015 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1016 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1017 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1018 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1019 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001021 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001022
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001023log-send-hostname [<string>]
1024 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1025 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1026 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1027 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1028 the logs.
1029
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001030log-tag <string>
1031 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1032 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1033 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001034 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001035
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001036lua-load <file>
1037 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1038 used multiple times.
1039
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001040master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001041 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1042 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1043 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001045 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1046 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001047 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1048 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1049 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1050 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1051 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001052
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001053 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001054
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001055mworker-max-reloads <number>
1056 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001057 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001058 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1059 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1060 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1061
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062nbproc <number>
1063 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1064 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1065 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001066 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1067 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001068 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1069 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001071nbthread <number>
1072 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001073 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1074 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1075 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1076 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1077 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001078 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1079 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1080 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1081 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1082 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1083 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1084 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001085
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1089 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1090
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001091presetenv <name> <value>
1092 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1093 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1094 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1095 and "unsetenv".
1096
1097resetenv [<name> ...]
1098 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1099 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1100 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1101 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1102 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1103 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1104 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1105 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1106
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001107stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001108 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1109 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1110 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1111 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1112 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1113 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001114 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001115 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1116 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1117 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1118 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001119
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120server-state-base <directory>
1121 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001122 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1123 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001124
1125server-state-file <file>
1126 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1127 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1128 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1129 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1130 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1131 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1132 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1133 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001134 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1135 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001136
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001137setenv <name> <value>
1138 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1139 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1140 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1141 and "unsetenv".
1142
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001143set-dumpable
1144 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001145 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1146 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1147 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1148 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1149 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1150 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1151 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1152 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1153 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1154 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1155 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1156 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1157 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1158 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1159 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1160 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1161 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001162
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001163ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1165 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001166 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001168 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1169 information and recommendations see e.g.
1170 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1171 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1172 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1173 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001174
1175ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1177 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1178 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1179 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1180 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001181 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1182 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1183 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001184 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001185
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001186ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1188 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1189 keyword to see available options.
1190
1191 Example:
1192 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001193 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001194
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001195ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1197 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001198 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001199 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001200 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1201 information and recommendations see e.g.
1202 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1203 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1204 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1205 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1206 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001207
1208ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1210 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1211 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1212 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1213 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001214 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1215 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1216 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1217 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001218
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001219ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1221 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1222 keyword to see available options.
1223
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001224ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1226 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1227 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001228 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001229 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001230 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1231 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1232 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1233 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001234 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1235 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1236 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1237
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001238ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1239 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1240 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1241 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1242
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001243stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1244 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1245 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1246 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001247 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001248 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001249
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001250 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1251 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1252 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001253
1254stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1255 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1256 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001257 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001258
1259stats maxconn <connections>
1260 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1261 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1262
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001263uid <number>
1264 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1265 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1266 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1267 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1268
1269ulimit-n <number>
1270 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1271 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1272 option.
1273
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001274unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1275 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1276
1277 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1278 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1279 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1280 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1281 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1282 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1283 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1284 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1285 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1286 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1287
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001288unsetenv [<name> ...]
1289 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1290 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1291 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1292 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1293 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1294 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1295 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001297user <user name>
1298 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1299 See also "uid" and "group".
1300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001301node <name>
1302 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1303
1304 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1305 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1306 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1307 traffic.
1308
1309description <text>
1310 Add a text that describes the instance.
1311
1312 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1313 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1314 "<" and ">" characters.
1315
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100131651degrees-data-file <file path>
1317 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001318 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001319
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001320 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001321 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1322
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000132351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001324 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1325 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1326 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1327
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001328 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001329 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1330
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200133151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001332 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1333 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1334
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001335 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1336 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1337
133851degrees-cache-size <number>
1339 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1340 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1341 By default, this cache is disabled.
1342
1343 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001344 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1345
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001346wurfl-data-file <file path>
1347 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1348 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1349
1350 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1351 with USE_WURFL=1.
1352
1353wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1354 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1355 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1356 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1357
1358 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1359
1360 Valid WURFL properties are:
1361 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1362
1363 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1364 device.
1365
1366 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1367 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1368
1369 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1370 particular web request.
1371
1372 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1373 used Libwurfl API version.
1374
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001375 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1376 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1377
1378 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1379 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1380
1381 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1382
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001383 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1384 with USE_WURFL=1.
1385
1386wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1387 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1388 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1389
1390 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1391 with USE_WURFL=1.
1392
1393wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1394 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1395 thus before the chroot.
1396
1397 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1398 with USE_WURFL=1.
1399
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001400wurfl-cache-size <size>
1401 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1402 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001403 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001404 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001405
1406 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1407 with USE_WURFL=1.
1408
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001409strict-limits
1410 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1411 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1412 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1413 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1414 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1415 keyword.
1416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014173.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001418-----------------------
1419
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001420busy-polling
1421 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1422 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1423 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1424 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1425 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1426 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1427 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1428 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1429 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1430 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1431 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1432 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1433 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1434 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1435 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1436 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1437 "poll" pollers.
1438
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001439max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1440 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1441 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1442 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1443 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1444 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1445 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1446 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1447 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001449maxconn <number>
1450 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1451 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1452 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001453 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1454 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1455 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1456 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001457 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1458 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1459 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1460 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1461 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1462 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001464maxconnrate <number>
1465 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1466 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1467 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1468 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1469 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1470 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1471 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1472 fairness.
1473
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001474maxcomprate <number>
1475 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001477 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1478 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1479 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001480 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001481 default value.
1482
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001483maxcompcpuusage <number>
1484 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1485 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1486 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1487 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1488 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1489 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1490 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1491 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1492
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001493maxpipes <number>
1494 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1495 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1496 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1497 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1498 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1499 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1500
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001501maxsessrate <number>
1502 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1503 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1504 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1505 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1506 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1507 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1508 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1509 fairness.
1510
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001511maxsslconn <number>
1512 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1513 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1514 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1515 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1516 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1517 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1518 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001519 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1520 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1521 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1522 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1523 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1524 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1525 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001526
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001527maxsslrate <number>
1528 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1529 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1530 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1531 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1532 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1533 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1534 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1535 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1536 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1537 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1538
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001539maxzlibmem <number>
1540 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1541 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1542 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001543 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1544 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1545 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001547noepoll
1548 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1549 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001550 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001551
1552nokqueue
1553 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1554 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1555 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1556
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001557noevports
1558 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1559 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1560 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1561 also "nopoll".
1562
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001563nopoll
1564 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1565 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001567 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1568 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001570nosplice
1571 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001572 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001573 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001574 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001575 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1576 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1577 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1578 "option splice-response".
1579
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001580nogetaddrinfo
1581 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1582 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1583
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001584noreuseport
1585 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1586 command line argument "-dR".
1587
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001588profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1589 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1590 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1591 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1592 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001593 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001594 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1595 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1596 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1597 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1598
1599 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1600 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1601 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1602 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1603 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001604 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1605 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1606 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1607 CLI.
1608
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001609spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001610 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1611 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1612 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1613 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1614 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1615 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001617ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001618 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001619 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001620 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1621 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1622 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1623 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1624 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1626 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001627 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1628 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1629 openssl configuration file uses:
1630 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1631
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001632ssl-mode-async
1633 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001634 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001635 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1636 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1637 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001638 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001639 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001640
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001641tune.buffers.limit <number>
1642 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1643 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1644 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1645 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1646 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001648 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1649 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1650 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1651 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1652 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1653 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1654 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1655 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1656 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1657
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001658tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1659 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1660 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1661 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1662 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1663
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001664tune.bufsize <number>
1665 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1666 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1667 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1668 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1669 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1670 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1671 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001672 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1673 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1674 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001675 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001676 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1677 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1678 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001679
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001680tune.chksize <number>
1681 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1682 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1683 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1684 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1685 checks whenever possible.
1686
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001687tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1688 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1689 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1690 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1691 this value. The default value is 1.
1692
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001693tune.fail-alloc
1694 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1695 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1696 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1697 gracefully.
1698
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001699tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1700 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1701 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1702 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1703 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1704 change it.
1705
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001706tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1707 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1709 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001710 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1711 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1712 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1713 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1714 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1715
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001716tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1717 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1718 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1719 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1720 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1721 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1722 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1723 recommended not to change this value.
1724
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001725tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1726 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1727 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1728 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1729 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1730 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1731 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1732 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1733
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001734tune.http.cookielen <number>
1735 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1736 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1737 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1738 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1739 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1740 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1741 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1742 to change this value.
1743
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001744tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001745 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1746 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001747 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001749 configuration directives too.
1750 The default value is 1024.
1751
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001752tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1753 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1754 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1755 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1756 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1757 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1758 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001759 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1760 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1761 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001762
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001763tune.idletimer <timeout>
1764 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1765 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1766 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1767 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1768 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1769 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001771 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001772 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1773
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001774tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1775 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1776 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1777 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1778 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1779 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1780 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1781 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1782 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1783 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1784
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001785tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1786 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001787 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001788 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1789 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001790 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001791 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1792 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1793
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001794tune.lua.maxmem
1795 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1796 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1797 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1798 memory.
1799
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001800tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1801 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001802 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1803 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001804 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001805
1806tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1807 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1808 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1809 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1810 check servers.
1811
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001812tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1813 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1814 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1815 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001816 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001817
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001818tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001819 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1820 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1821 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1822 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1823 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1824 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1825 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1826 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1827 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1828 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001829
1830tune.maxpollevents <number>
1831 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1832 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1833 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1834 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1835 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1836
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001837tune.maxrewrite <number>
1838 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1839 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1840 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1841 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1842 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1843 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1844 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1845 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1846 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1847 bufsize.
1848
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001849tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1850 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1851 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1852 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1853 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1854 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1855 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1856 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1857 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1858 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001859 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1860 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001861 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1862 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1863 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1864 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1865 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1866 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1867 setting this parameter to 0.
1868
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001869tune.pipesize <number>
1870 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1871 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1872 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1873 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1874 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1875 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1876
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001877tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1878 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1879 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1880 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1881 default is 20.
1882
1883tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1884 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1885 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1886 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1887 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1888 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1889 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001890 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001891
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001892tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1893tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1894 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1895 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1896 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001897 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001899 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1900 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1901
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001902tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001903 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001904 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1905 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1906 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1907 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1908
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001909tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001910 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001911 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1912 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1913
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001914tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1915tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1916 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1917 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1918 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001919 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001920 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001921 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1922 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1923 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1924 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1925 notifying haproxy again.
1926
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001927tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001928 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1929 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1930 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001931 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001932 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001933 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001934 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1935 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1936 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001937 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1938 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001939
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001940tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001941 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001942 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1943 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1944 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1945 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1946 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1947
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001948tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1949 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001950 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001951 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1952 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1953 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1954 being used for too long.
1955
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001956tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1957 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1958 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1959 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1960 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1961 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1962 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1963 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1964 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1965 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1966 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001967 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001968 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001969
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001970tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1971 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1972 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1973 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1974 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1975 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1976 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1977 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001978 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1979 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001980
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001981tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1982 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1983 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1984 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1985 1000 entries.
1986
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001987tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1988 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1989 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1990 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1991
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001993tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001994tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1995tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1996tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001997 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1998 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1999 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2000 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2001 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2002 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2003 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2004 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002005
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002006 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2007 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2008 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2009 all available space is consumed.
2010 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2011 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2012 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002013
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002014tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2015 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002016 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002017 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002018 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002019 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2020
2021tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2022 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2023 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002024 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2025 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020273.3. Debugging
2028--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002029
2030debug
2031 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2032 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2033 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2034 system startup.
2035
2036quiet
2037 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2038 line argument "-q".
2039
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020413.4. Userlists
2042--------------
2043It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2044http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2045it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2046
2047userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002048 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002049 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2050
2051group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002052 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2054 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2055
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002056user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2057 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2059 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002060 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2061 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2062 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2063 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002064
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002065 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2066 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2067 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2068 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2069 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2070 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2071 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2072 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2073 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002074
2075 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002076 userlist L1
2077 group G1 users tiger,scott
2078 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002079
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002080 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2081 user scott insecure-password elgato
2082 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002083
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002084 userlist L2
2085 group G1
2086 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002087
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002088 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2089 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2090 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002091
2092 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002093
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002094
20953.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002097It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2098several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2099instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2100values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2101automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2102In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2103using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2104tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2105reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2106Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2107that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2108each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002109
2110peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002111 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002112 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2113
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002114bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2115 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2116 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2117
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002118disabled
2119 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2120 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2121 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2122
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002123default-bind [param*]
2124 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2125
2126default-server [param*]
2127 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2128
2129 Arguments:
2130 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2131 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2132 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2133 details.
2134
2135
2136 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2137
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002138enable
2139 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2140
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002141log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2142 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2143 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2144 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2145 more details.
2146
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002147peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002148 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2149 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2150 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2151 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2152 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2153 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2154
2155 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2156 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2157
2158 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2159 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2160 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2161 across all peers.
2162
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002163 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2164 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002166 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2167 "server" keyword explanation below).
2168
2169server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002170 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002171 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2172 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2173 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2174 of this "peers" section).
2175 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2176
2177
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002178 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002179 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002180 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002181 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2182 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2183 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002184
2185 backend mybackend
2186 mode tcp
2187 balance roundrobin
2188 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2189 stick on src
2190
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002191 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2192 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002193
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002194 Example:
2195 peers mypeers
2196 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2197 default-server ssl verify none
2198 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2199 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002200
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002201
2202table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2203 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2204
2205 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2206 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002207 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002208 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2209 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2210 "stick-table" keyword).
2211
2212 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2213 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2214 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2215 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2216 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2217 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2218 of the stick-table name as follows:
2219
2220 peers mypeers
2221 peer A ...
2222 peer B ...
2223 table t1 ...
2224
2225 frontend fe1
2226 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2227
2228 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2229 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2230
2231 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2232 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2233 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2234 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2235 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2236 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2237 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2238
2239 peers mypeers
2240 peer A ...
2241 peer B ...
2242 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2243
2244 backend t1
2245 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2246
2247 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2248 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2249 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2250
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022513.6. Mailers
2252------------
2253It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2254If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2255in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2256
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002257mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002258 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2259 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2260
2261mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2262 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2263
2264 Example:
2265 mailers mymailers
2266 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2267 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2268
2269 backend mybackend
2270 mode tcp
2271 balance roundrobin
2272
2273 email-alert mailers mymailers
2274 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2275 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2276
2277 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2278 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2279
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002280timeout mail <time>
2281 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2282 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2283 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2284 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2285
2286 Example:
2287 mailers mymailers
2288 timeout mail 20s
2289 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002290
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022913.7. Programs
2292-------------
2293In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2294master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2295managed the same way as the workers.
2296
2297During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2298sequence as a worker:
2299
2300 - the master is re-executed
2301 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2302 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2303 instance of the program
2304
2305During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2306
2307program <name>
2308 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2309 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2310 the management guide).
2311
2312command <command> [arguments*]
2313 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2314 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2315 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2316 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2317
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002318user <user name>
2319 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2320 See also "group".
2321
2322group <group name>
2323 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2324 See also "user".
2325
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002326option start-on-reload
2327no option start-on-reload
2328 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2329 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2330 program section.
2331
2332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002334----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002336Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002337 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002338 - frontend <name>
2339 - backend <name>
2340 - listen <name>
2341
2342A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2343its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2344section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002346
2347A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2348connections.
2349
2350A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2351to forward incoming connections.
2352
2353A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2354parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2357'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2358case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2359
2360Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2361logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2362proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2363However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2364name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2365
2366Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2367and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002368bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2370modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2371arbitrary criteria.
2372
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002373In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2374a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002375the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
2377 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2378 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2379 between responses and new requests.
2380
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002381 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2382 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2383 client-facing connection remains open.
2384
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002385 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2386 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002387
2388The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2389frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2390following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002391weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002392
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002393 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002394
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002395 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2396 ----+-----+-----+----
2397 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2398 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002399 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2400 ----+-----+-----+----
2401 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2406--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002408The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2409limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2410they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2411limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002412marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002413option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002414and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2415with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2416specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002418
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2420------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2421acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002422backlog X X X -
2423balance X - X X
2424bind - X X -
2425bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002426capture cookie - X X -
2427capture request header - X X -
2428capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002429compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002430cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002431declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002432default-server X - X X
2433default_backend X X X -
2434description - X X X
2435disabled X X X X
2436dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002437email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002438email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002439email-alert mailers X X X X
2440email-alert myhostname X X X X
2441email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002442enabled X X X X
2443errorfile X X X X
2444errorloc X X X X
2445errorloc302 X X X X
2446-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2447errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002448force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002449filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002450fullconn X - X X
2451grace X X X X
2452hash-type X - X X
2453http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002454http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002455http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002456http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002457http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002458http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002459http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002461ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002462load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002463log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002464log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002465log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002466log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002467max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468maxconn X X X -
2469mode X X X X
2470monitor fail - X X -
2471monitor-net X X X -
2472monitor-uri X X X -
2473option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2474option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2475option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2476option allbackups (*) X - X X
2477option checkcache (*) X - X X
2478option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2479option contstats (*) X X X -
2480option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2481option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2483option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002484option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2485option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002486option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002487option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002488option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002489option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002490option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2492option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2493option httpchk X - X X
2494option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002495option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002497option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002498option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002499option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2501option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2502option logasap (*) X X X -
2503option mysql-check X - X X
2504option nolinger (*) X X X X
2505option originalto X X X X
2506option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002507option pgsql-check X - X X
2508option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002509option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002510option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002511option smtpchk X - X X
2512option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2513option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2514option splice-request (*) X X X X
2515option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002516option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002517option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2518option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2519-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002520option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002521option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2522option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2523option tcpka X X X X
2524option tcplog X X X X
2525option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002526external-check command X - X X
2527external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002528persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2529rate-limit sessions X X X -
2530redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002532retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002533retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002534server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002535server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002536server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002537source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002538stats admin - X X X
2539stats auth X X X X
2540stats enable X X X X
2541stats hide-version X X X X
2542stats http-request - X X X
2543stats realm X X X X
2544stats refresh X X X X
2545stats scope X X X X
2546stats show-desc X X X X
2547stats show-legends X X X X
2548stats show-node X X X X
2549stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002550-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2551stick match - - X X
2552stick on - - X X
2553stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002554stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002555stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002556tcp-check connect - - X X
2557tcp-check expect - - X X
2558tcp-check send - - X X
2559tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002560tcp-request connection - X X -
2561tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002562tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002563tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002564tcp-response content - - X X
2565tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002566timeout check X - X X
2567timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002568timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002570timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2571timeout http-request X X X X
2572timeout queue X - X X
2573timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002574timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002575timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002576timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002577transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002578unique-id-format X X X -
2579unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002581use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002582use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2584 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025874.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2588---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589
2590This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2591
2592
2593acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2594 Declare or complete an access list.
2595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2596 no | yes | yes | yes
2597 Example:
2598 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2599 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2600 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002602 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
2604
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002605backlog <conns>
2606 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2608 yes | yes | yes | no
2609 Arguments :
2610 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2611 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002612 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002613
2614 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2615 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2616 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2617 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2618 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2619 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2620 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2621 backlog parameter.
2622
2623 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2624 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2625 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2626
2627 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2628
2629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002630balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002631balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 yes | no | yes | yes
2635 Arguments :
2636 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2637 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2638 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2639 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2640
2641 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2642 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2643 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2644 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002645 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002646 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002647 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2648 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2649 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2650 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2651 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2652 it, so that you don't worry.
2653
2654 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2655 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2656 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2657 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2658 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2659 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2660 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2661 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002663 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2664 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2665 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2666 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2667 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2668 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2669 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2670 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2671
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002672 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002673 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002674 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2675 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002676 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2678 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2679 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2680 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2681 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002682 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2683 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2684 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2685 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2686 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2687 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2690 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2691 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2692 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2693 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2694 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2695 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2696 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002699 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2700 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2701 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002703 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2704 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2705 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2706 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2707 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2708 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2709 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2710 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2711 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2712 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2713 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2714 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002716 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002717 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2718 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2719 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2720 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2721 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2722 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2723 URIs start with a leading "/".
2724
2725 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2726 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2727 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2728 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002731 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2732
2733 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002734 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2735 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002736 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2737 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2738 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2739 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002740 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2742 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002743
2744 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2745 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2746 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2747 server will receive the request.
2748
2749 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2750 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2751 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2752 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2753 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002754 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2755 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2756 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002758 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2759 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2760 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2761 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2762 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002764 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002765 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2766 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2767 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2768
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002769 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2770 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2771 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2772
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002773 random
2774 random(<draws>)
2775 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002776 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2777 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2778 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2779 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002780 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2781 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2782 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2783 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2784 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2785 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2786 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2787 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2788 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2789 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2790 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2791 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2792 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2793 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2794 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2795 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2796 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2797 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2798 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2799 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002800
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002801 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002802 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002803 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2804 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2805 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2806 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2807 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2808 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002809 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002810 used instead.
2811
2812 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2813 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2814 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2815 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2816
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002817 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2818 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2819 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2820
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002821 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002824 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2825 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002826
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002827 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2828 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2829 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002831 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002832 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002833 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2834 NTLM relies on.
2835
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 Examples :
2837 balance roundrobin
2838 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002839 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002840 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2841 balance hdr(host)
2842 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002843
2844 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2845 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002847 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2849 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2850 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002851 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002852
2853 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2854 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2855 defaults to 16 kB.
2856
2857 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2858 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2859
2860 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2861 Round Robin.
2862
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002863 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002864 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2865 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2866 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2867
2868 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2869
2870 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002871 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002872 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2873 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2874 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002876 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
2878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002879bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2880bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 no | yes | yes | no
2884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002885 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2886 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2887 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2888 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002889 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002890 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2891 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2892 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2893 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2894 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2895 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2896 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002897 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2898 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2899 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2900 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2901 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2902 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2903 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002904 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2905 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2906 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002907 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2908 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2909 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2910 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002911 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2912 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2913 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002914
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002915 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2916 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002917 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2918 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2919 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2921 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2922 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2923 the range.
2924
2925 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2926 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2927 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2928 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2929 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2930 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2931 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002932 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002933 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002935 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002936 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002937 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2938 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2939 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2940 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2941 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2942 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002944 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2945 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2946 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2947 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2950 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2951 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2952 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2953 in a frontend.
2954
2955 Example :
2956 listen http_proxy
2957 bind :80,:443
2958 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002959 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002961 listen http_https_proxy
2962 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002963 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002964
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002965 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2966 bind ipv6@:80
2967 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2968 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2969
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002970 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002971 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002972
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002973 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2974 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2975 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2976 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2977 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2978
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002979 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002980 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981
2982
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002983bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002984 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2986 yes | yes | yes | yes
2987 Arguments :
2988 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2989 may be used to override a default value.
2990
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002991 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002992 option may be combined with other numbers.
2993
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002994 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002995 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2996 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2997 missing from all processes.
2998
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002999 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003000 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003001 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3002 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3003 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3004 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3005 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003006 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003007
3008 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3009 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3010 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3011 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3012 and 'even' instances.
3013
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003014 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3015 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3016 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3017 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003018
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003019 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3020 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3021
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003022 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3023 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3024 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3025
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003026 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3027 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3028
3029 Example :
3030 listen app_ip1
3031 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003032 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003033
3034 listen app_ip2
3035 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003036 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003037
3038 listen management
3039 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003040 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003041
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003042 listen management
3043 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3044 bind-process 1-4
3045
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003046 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003047
3048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049capture cookie <name> len <length>
3050 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3052 no | yes | yes | no
3053 Arguments :
3054 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3055 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3056 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3057 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003058 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003059
3060 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3061 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3062 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3063 right if it exceeds <length>.
3064
3065 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3066 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3067 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3068 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3069
3070 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3071 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3072 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3073
3074 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3075 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3076 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003077 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3078 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3079 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080
3081 Example:
3082 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3083
3084 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086
3087
3088capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003089 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 no | yes | yes | no
3092 Arguments :
3093 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003094 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3096 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3097 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3098
3099 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3100 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3101 it exceeds <length>.
3102
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003103 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3105 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003106 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3107 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3108 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3109 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003110 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003111 environments to find where the request came from.
3112
3113 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3114 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3115 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3116 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003118 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3119 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3120 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3121 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3122 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123
3124 Example:
3125 capture request header Host len 15
3126 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003127 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003129 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 about logging.
3131
3132
3133capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003134 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 no | yes | yes | no
3137 Arguments :
3138 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003139 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3141 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3142 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3143
3144 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3145 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3146 it exceeds <length>.
3147
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003148 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3150 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3151 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003152 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3153 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3154 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3155 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003157 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3158 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3159 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3160 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3161 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
3163 Example:
3164 capture response header Content-length len 9
3165 capture response header Location len 15
3166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003167 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 about logging.
3169
3170
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003171compression algo <algorithm> ...
3172compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003173compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003174 Enable HTTP compression.
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | yes | yes | yes
3177 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003178 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3179 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3180 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3181
3182 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003183 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3184 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3185 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003186
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003187 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003188 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003189
3190 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3191 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3192 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3193 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3194 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003195 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003196
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003197 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3198 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3199 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3200 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3201 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3202 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3203 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003204 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003205
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003206 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003207 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003208 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3209 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3210 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3211 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3212 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003213
3214 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3215 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3216 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3217 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3218 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003219 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3220 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3221 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3222 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3223 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003224 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3225 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003226
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003227 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003228 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3229 "Accept-Encoding" header
3230 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003231 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003232 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3233 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3234 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3235 "multipart"
3236 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3237 header
3238 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3239 and later
3240 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3241 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003242 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003243
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003244 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003245
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003246 Examples :
3247 compression algo gzip
3248 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003250
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003251cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003252 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3253 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003254 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003255 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | no | yes | yes
3258 Arguments :
3259 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3260 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3261 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3262 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3263 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3264 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003265 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003266 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3267 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3268
3269 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3270 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3271 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3272 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3273 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3274 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003275 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3276 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003277 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003278 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3279 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280
3281 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003282 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003283
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003284 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003285 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003286 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003287 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003288 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3289 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3290 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3291 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3292 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3293 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3294 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295
3296 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3297 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3298 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3299 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3300 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3301 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3302 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3303 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3304 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003305 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003306 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3307 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3308 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003310 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3311 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3312 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003313 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3314 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3315 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3316 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003317 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3318 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3319 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320
3321 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3322 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3323 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3324 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3325 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3326 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3327 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3328 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3329 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3330
3331 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3332 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3333 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3334 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3335 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3336 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3337 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3338 persistence cookie in the cache.
3339 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3340
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003341 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3342 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3343 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3344 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3345 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003346 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003347 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3348 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3349 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3350 they logout.
3351
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3353 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3354 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3355 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3356
3357 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3358 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3359 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3360 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3361 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3362 this attribute.
3363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003364 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003365 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003366 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3367 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3368 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3369 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3370 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3371 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003372
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003373 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3374 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3375 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3376 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3377 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3378 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3379 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003382 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3383 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3384 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3385 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3386 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3387 the site.
3388
3389 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3390 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3391 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3392 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3393 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3394 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3395 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3396 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3397 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3398 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3399 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3400 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3401 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003402 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003403 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3404 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3405
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003406 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3407 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3408 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3409 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3410 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3411 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003413 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3414 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3415 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3416 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418 Examples :
3419 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3420 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3421 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003422 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003424 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003426
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003427declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3428 Declares a capture slot.
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 no | yes | yes | no
3431 Arguments:
3432 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3433
3434 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3435 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3436 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3437 for use in the response.
3438
3439 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003440 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003441 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3442
3443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003444default-server [param*]
3445 Change default options for a server in a backend
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | no | yes | yes
3448 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003449 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3450 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3451 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3452 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003453
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003454 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003455 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3456
3457 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003458
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460default_backend <backend>
3461 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | yes | yes | no
3464 Arguments :
3465 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3466
3467 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3468 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3469 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3470 will catch all undetermined requests.
3471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472 Example :
3473
3474 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3475 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3476 default_backend dynamic
3477
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003478 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003481description <string>
3482 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3484 no | yes | yes | yes
3485 Arguments : string
3486
3487 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3488 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3489 it describes.
3490 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3491
3492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493disabled
3494 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 yes | yes | yes | yes
3497 Arguments : none
3498
3499 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3500 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3501 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3502 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3503 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3504 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3505 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3506
3507 See also : "enabled"
3508
3509
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003510dispatch <address>:<port>
3511 Set a default server address
3512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003515
3516 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3517 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3518 during start-up.
3519
3520 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3521 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3522 possible with normal servers.
3523
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003524 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003525 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3526 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3527 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3528 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3529
3530 See also : "server"
3531
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003532
3533dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3534 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | no | yes | yes
3537 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3538
3539 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003540 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003541 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3542 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003543 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003544 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003546enabled
3547 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | yes | yes | yes
3550 Arguments : none
3551
3552 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3553 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3554
3555 See also : "disabled"
3556
3557
3558errorfile <code> <file>
3559 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | yes | yes | yes
3562 Arguments :
3563 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003564 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3565 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003566
3567 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003568 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003570 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3571 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003572
3573 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3574 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3575 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3576
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003577 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3580 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3581 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3582 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3583
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003584 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3585 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003586 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003587 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3588 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3589 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3592 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3593 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003594 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3596
3597 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3598
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003599 Example :
3600 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003601 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003602 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3603 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605
3606errorloc <code> <url>
3607errorloc302 <code> <url>
3608 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3610 yes | yes | yes | yes
3611 Arguments :
3612 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003613 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3614 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615
3616 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3617 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3618 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3619 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003620 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003621
3622 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3623 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3624 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3625
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003626 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3627
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003628 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3629 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3630 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3631 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003632 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003633 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3634 request.
3635
3636 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3637
3638
3639errorloc303 <code> <url>
3640 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | yes | yes | yes
3643 Arguments :
3644 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003645 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3646 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647
3648 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3649 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3650 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3651 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003652 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
3654 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3655 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3656 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3657
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003658 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3659
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003660 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3661 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3662 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3663 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003664 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003665
3666 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3667
3668
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003669email-alert from <emailaddr>
3670 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003671 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | yes
3674
3675 Arguments :
3676
3677 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3678
3679 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3680 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3681
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003682 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003683 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3684 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003685
3686
3687email-alert level <level>
3688 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3689 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 yes | yes | yes | yes
3692
3693 Arguments :
3694
3695 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3696 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3697 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3698
3699 By default level is alert
3700
3701 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3702 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3703 for the proxy.
3704
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003705 Alerts are sent when :
3706
3707 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3708 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3709 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3710 is notice or lower
3711 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3712 and a health check status update occurs
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3715 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716 section 3.6 about mailers.
3717
3718
3719email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3720 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723
3724 Arguments :
3725
3726 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3727
3728 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3729 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3730
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003731 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3732 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003733
3734
3735email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3736 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3737 mailers.
3738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740
3741 Arguments :
3742
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003743 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003744
3745 By default the systems hostname is used.
3746
3747 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3748 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3749 for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3752 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003753
3754
3755email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003756 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003757 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760
3761 Arguments :
3762
3763 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3764
3765 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3766 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3767
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003768 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003769 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3770
3771
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003772force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3773 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003775 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003776
3777 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3778 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3779 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3780 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3781 marked down for maintenance operations.
3782
3783 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3784 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3785 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3786 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3787 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3788 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3789 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3790 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3791 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3792
3793 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3794 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3795 is used.
3796
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003797 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003798 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003799
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003800
3801filter <name> [param*]
3802 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3804 no | yes | yes | yes
3805 Arguments :
3806 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3807 referenced in section 9.
3808
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003809 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003810 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003811 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3812 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003813
3814 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3815 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3816
3817 Example:
3818 listen
3819 bind *:80
3820
3821 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3822 filter compression
3823 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3824
3825 compression algo gzip
3826 compression offload
3827
3828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3829
3830 See also : section 9.
3831
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833fullconn <conns>
3834 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 yes | no | yes | yes
3837 Arguments :
3838 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3839 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3840
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003841 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003842 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003843 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003844 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3845 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3846 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3847 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3848 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003849 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003851 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3852 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003853 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3854 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3855 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003856
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003857 Example :
3858 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3859 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3860 # connections.
3861 backend dynamic
3862 fullconn 10000
3863 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3864 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3865
3866 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3867
3868
3869grace <time>
3870 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003872 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003873 Arguments :
3874 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3875 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3876 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3877
3878 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3879 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003880 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003881 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3882
3883 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3884 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3885 simplify it.
3886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003887
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003888hash-balance-factor <factor>
3889 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | no | no | yes
3892 Arguments :
3893 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3894 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003895 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003896
3897 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3898 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3899 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3900 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3901 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3902 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3903 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3904
3905 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3906 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3907 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3908 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3909 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3910
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003911 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3912 consistent hashing mechanism.
3913
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003914 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3915
3916
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003917hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003918 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | no | yes | yes
3921 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003922 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3923 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003924
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003925 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3926 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3927 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3928 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3929 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3930 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3931 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3932 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3933 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3934 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003935
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003936 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3937 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3938 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3939 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3940 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3941 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3942 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3943 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3944 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3945 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3946 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3947 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3948 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003949 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3950 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003951
3952 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3953
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003954 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003955 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3956 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3957 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003958 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3959 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3960 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003961
3962 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3963 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003964 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3965 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3966 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3967 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3968
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003969 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3970 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3971 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3972 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3973 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3974 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3975 parameter.
3976
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003977 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3978 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3979 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3980 used on strings.
3981
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003982 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3983
3984 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3985 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3986 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3987 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3988 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3989 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3990 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3991 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3992 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3993 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3994 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3995 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003996
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003997 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3998 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3999 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004000
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004002
4003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004http-check disable-on-404
4005 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004007 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4011 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4012 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4013 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4014 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4015 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4016 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4017 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004018 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4019 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4020 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4021
4022 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4023
4024
4025http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004026 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004028 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004029 Arguments :
4030 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4031 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004032 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004033 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4034 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4035 details on the supported keywords.
4036
4037 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4038 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4039 with the usual backslash ('\').
4040
4041 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4042 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4043 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4044 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4045 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4046
4047 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004048 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004049 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4050 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4051 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4052
4053 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4056 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4057 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4058 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4059
4060 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004061 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004062 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4063 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4064 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4065 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4066 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004067 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004068 trace).
4069
4070 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004071 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004072 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4073 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4074 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4075 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4076 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004077 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004078
4079 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4080 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4081 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4082 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4083 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4084 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4085 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4086 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4087
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004088 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4089 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4090 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4091
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004092 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4093 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4094
4095 Examples :
4096 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004097 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098
4099 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004100 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004101
4102 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004103 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004104
4105 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004106 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004107
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004108 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004109
4110
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004111http-check send-state
4112 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4114 yes | no | yes | yes
4115 Arguments : none
4116
4117 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4118 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4119 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4120 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4121 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4122
4123 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4124 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4125 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4126 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4127 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004128 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4129 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4130 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4131
4132 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4133 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4134 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4135
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004136 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4137 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4138 checked in multiple backends.
4139
4140 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4141 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4142
4143 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4144 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4145 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4146 one fails.
4147
4148 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4149 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4150 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4151
4152 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4153 server's queue.
4154
4155 Example of a header received by the application server :
4156 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4157 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4158
4159 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161
4162http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004163 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4164
4165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 no | yes | yes | yes
4167
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004168 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4169 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4170 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4171 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4172 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4175 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 Example:
4180 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4181 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4182 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004184 http-request allow if nagios
4185 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4186 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4187 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 Example:
4190 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4191 acl add path /addacl
4192 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004194 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4197 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199 Example:
4200 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4201 acl setmap path /setmap
4202 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4207 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4210 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4215 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4216 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4217 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4218 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4219 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4220 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4221 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4226 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4227 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4228 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4229 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4230 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4231 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4232 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4237 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004238
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004240http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4243 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4244 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4245 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4246 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 Example:
4249 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4250 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004252http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004254 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4257 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4260 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4261 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4262 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4263 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4264 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4265 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4266 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4267 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4270 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4271 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4272 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4273 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4274 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4279 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4280 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4281 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4282 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4283 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4292 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4293 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4294 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4295 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4296 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004298http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4301 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4302 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4303 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4304 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004305
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004306http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4307 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4308 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4309 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4310
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004311http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4312
4313 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4314 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4315 pointed by <resolvers>.
4316 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4317 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4318 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4319 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4320 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4321 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4322 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4323 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4324 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4325 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4326 to 0.0.0.0.
4327
4328 Example:
4329 resolvers mydns
4330 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4331 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4332 timeout retry 1s
4333 hold valid 10s
4334 hold nx 3s
4335 hold other 3s
4336 hold obsolete 0s
4337 accepted_payload_size 8192
4338
4339 frontend fe
4340 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4341 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4342 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4343
4344 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4345 # which mean DNS resolution error
4346 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4347
4348 default_backend be
4349
4350 backend b_503
4351 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4352 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4353 # 503 error page to end users
4354
4355 backend be
4356 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4357 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4358 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4359 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4360 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4361
4362 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4363 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4364
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004365http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4366
4367 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4368 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4369 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4370 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004371 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4372 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004373
4374 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4379 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4380 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4381 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4382 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4387 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4388 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4389 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4392 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004393
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004394 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4395 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4396 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4397 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4398 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4399 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004400
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004401 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4402 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4403 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4404 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4405 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004406
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004407 Example:
4408 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4409
4410 # applied to:
4411 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4412
4413 # outputs:
4414 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4415
4416 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004417
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004418 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4419
4420 # applied to:
4421 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004422
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004423 # outputs:
4424 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004425
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004426http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4427 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4428
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004429 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4430 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4431 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4432 against.
4433
4434 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4435 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4436 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004438 Example:
4439 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4440 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004442 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4443 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004444
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004445 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4446 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4447 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4448 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004452
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004453 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4454 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4455 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4456 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004458 Example:
4459 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004460
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004461 # applied to:
4462 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004463
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004464 # outputs:
4465 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4468http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4471 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4472 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004476 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4477 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4478 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4483 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4484 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4485 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4486 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 Arguments:
4489 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4490 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 Example:
4493 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4494 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4497 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004499http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4502 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4503 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004505 Arguments:
4506 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4507 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509 Example:
4510 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4511 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004513 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4514 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4515 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004517http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4520 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4521 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4522 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4523 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 Example:
4526 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4527 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4528 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4533 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4534 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4539 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4540 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4541 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4542 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4548 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4549 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4550 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4551 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4552 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4553 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4554 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4555 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4560 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4561 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4562 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4563 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4564 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4565 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4570 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4571 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004575 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4576 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4577 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4578 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4579 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4580 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4581 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4582 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4587 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4588 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4589 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4590 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4591 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004593 Example :
4594 # prepend the host name before the path
4595 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4600 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4601 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4602 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4603 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004605http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4608 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4609 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4610 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4611 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4612 values have higher priority.
4613 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4614 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4615 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4616 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4617 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4622 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4623 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4624 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4625 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4626 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4627 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004630
4631 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4633 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4636 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4637 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4638 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4639 privacy.
4640
4641 Arguments :
4642 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4643 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004644
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004645 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4647 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4648
4649 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4650 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4651
4652http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4653
4654 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4655 expression.
4656
4657 Arguments:
4658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4659 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004660
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004661 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4663 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4664
4665 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4666 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4667 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4668
4669http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4670
4671 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4672 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4673 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4674 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4675 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4676 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4677 information from the request.
4678
4679 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4680
4681http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4682
4683 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4684 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4685 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4686 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4687 path and the query string.
4688 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4689
4690http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4691
4692 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4693 inline.
4694
4695 Arguments:
4696 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4697 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4698 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4699 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4700 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4701 (request and response)
4702 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4703 processing
4704 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4705 processing
4706 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4707 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4708 and '_'.
4709
4710 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4711 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004712
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004713 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4720 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4721 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4722 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4723 agent name must be used.
4724
4725 Arguments:
4726 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4727
4728 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4729 configuration.
4730
4731http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4732
4733 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4734 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4735 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4736 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4737 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4738 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4739 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4740 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4741 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4742 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4743 action.
4744 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4745 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4746 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4747 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4748 you fully understand how it works.
4749
4750http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4751
4752 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4753 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4754 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4755 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4756 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4757 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4758 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4759 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4760 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4761 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4762 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4763 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4764 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4765
4766http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4767http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4768http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4769
4770 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4771 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4772 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4773 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4774 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4775 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4776 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4777 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4778 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4779 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4780 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4781 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4782
4783 Arguments :
4784 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4785 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4786 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4787 select which table entry to update the counters.
4788
4789 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4790 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4791 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4792 that table until the session ends.
4793
4794 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4795 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4796 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4797 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4798 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4799 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4800 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4801 useful information.
4802
4803 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4804 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4805 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4806 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4807 checks that make use of it.
4808
4809http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4810
4811 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004812
4813 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004814 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004818 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4819 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4820 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004821
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004824 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4825
4826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 no | yes | yes | yes
4828
4829 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4830 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4831 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4832 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4833 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4834 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4837 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841 Example:
4842 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004844 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4847 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849 Example:
4850 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4855 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4858 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004862 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4863 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4864 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4865 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4866 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4867 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4868 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4869 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004871http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4874 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4875 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4876 example, or to pass some internal information.
4877 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4878 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4879 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4884 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004885
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004886http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004887
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004888 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004892 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4893 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4894 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4895 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4896 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4897 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4898 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4901 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4902 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4903 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4904 keyword.
4905 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4906 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4911 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4912 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4913 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4914 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4915 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004923 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4924 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4925 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4926 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4927 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4928 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004932 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4933 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004935http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4938 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4939 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4940 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4941 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4942 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4945 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004946
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004947 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
4948 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950 Example:
4951 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004953 # applied to:
4954 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956 # outputs:
4957 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004959 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004961http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004963
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004964 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
4965 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967 Example:
4968 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004970 # applied to:
4971 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 # outputs:
4974 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4977http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004979 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4980 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4981 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004983http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4986 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4987 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004989http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004991 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4992 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4993 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4994 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4995 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004997 Arguments:
4998 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5001 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005005 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5006 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5007 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005009http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5010
5011 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5012 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5013 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5014 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5015 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5016
5017http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5018
5019 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5020 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5021 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5022 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5023 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5024 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5025 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5026 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5027 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5028
5029http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5030
5031 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5032 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5033 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5034 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5035 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5036 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5037 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5038
5039http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5040
5041 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5042 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5043 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5044 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5045 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5046 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5047 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5048 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5049
5050http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5052
5053 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5054 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5055 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5056 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005057
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005058 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5060 http-response set-status 431
5061 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5062 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005066 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5067 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5068 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5069 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5070 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5071 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5072 based on some information from the request.
5073
5074 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5075
5076http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5077
5078 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5079 inline.
5080
5081 Arguments:
5082 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5083 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5084 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5085 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5086 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5087 (request and response)
5088 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5089 processing
5090 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5091 processing
5092 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5093 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5094 and '_'.
5095
5096 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5097 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005098
5099 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005104 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5105 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5106 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5107 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5108 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5109 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5110 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5111 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5112 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5113 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5114 action.
5115 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5116 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5117 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5118 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5119 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5122http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5123http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5126 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5127 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5128 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5129 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5130 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5131
5132http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5133
5134 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5135 about <var-name>.
5136
5137 Example:
5138 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5139
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005140
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005141http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5142 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5143
5144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5145 yes | no | yes | yes
5146
5147 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005148 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5149 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5150 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005151
5152 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5153
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005154 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5155 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5156 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5157 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5158 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5159 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5160 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5161 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5162 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5163 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005164
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005165 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5166 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5167 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5168 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5169 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5170 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5171 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5172 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005173
5174 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5175 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5176 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5177 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5178 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5179 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5180 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5181 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005182 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005183 downsides of rare connection failures.
5184
5185 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5186 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5187 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5188 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5189 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5190 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005191 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005192 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5193 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5194 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5195 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5196 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5197
5198 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005199 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5200 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5201 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005202
5203 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005204 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005205
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005206 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5207 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005208
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005209 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005210
5211 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5212 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5213 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5214
5215 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5216
5217
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005218http-send-name-header [<header>]
5219 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005222 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005223 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5224
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005225 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5226 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5227 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5228 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5229 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5230 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5231 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5232 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5233 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5234 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5235 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5236 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5237 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5238 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5239 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5240 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005241
5242 See also : "server"
5243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005244id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005245 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5247 no | yes | yes | yes
5248 Arguments : none
5249
5250 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5251 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5252 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005253
5254
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005255ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5256 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005258 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005259
5260 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5261 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5262 and running).
5263
5264 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5265 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5266 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005267 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005268 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5269
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005270 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5271 "unless" condition is met.
5272
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005273 Example:
5274 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5275 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5276 ignore-persist if url_static
5277
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005278 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5279
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005280load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5281 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
5284
5285 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5286 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5287 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005288 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005289 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5290 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5291 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5292 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005294 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005295 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005296 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005297
5298 Arguments:
5299 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5300 named "server-state-file".
5301
5302 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5303 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5304 name is used as a file name.
5305
5306 none don't load any stat for this backend
5307
5308 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005309 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5310 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5311 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005312 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005313 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005314
5315 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5316 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5317
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005318 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005319
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005320 global
5321 stats socket /tmp/socket
5322 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005323
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005324 defaults
5325 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005326
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005327 backend bk
5328 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5329 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005330
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005331
5332 Then one can run :
5333
5334 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5335
5336 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5337
5338 1
5339 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5340 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5341 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5342
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005343 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005344
5345 global
5346 stats socket /tmp/socket
5347 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5348
5349 defaults
5350 load-server-state-from-file local
5351
5352 backend bk
5353 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5354 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5355
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005356
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005357 Then one can run :
5358
5359 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5360
5361 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5362
5363 1
5364 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5365 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5366 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5367
5368 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5369 "show servers state"
5370
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005371
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005372log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005373log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5374 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005375no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005376 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005379
5380 Prefix :
5381 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5382 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5383 prefix does not allow arguments.
5384
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005385 Arguments :
5386 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5387 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5388 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5389 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5390 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5391 parameter.
5392
5393 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5394 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5395
5396 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5397 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5398 standard syslog port).
5399
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005400 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5401 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5402 standard syslog port).
5403
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005404 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5405 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5406 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005407 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005408
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005409 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5410 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5411 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5412 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5413 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5414 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5415 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5416 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5417 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5418 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5419 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5420 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5421 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5422 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5423 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5424 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005425 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5426 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005427
5428 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5429 and "fd@2", see above.
5430
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005431 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5432 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5433 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5434 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5435 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5436 having the logs instantly available.
5437
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005438 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5439 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005440
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005441 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5442 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5443 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5444 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5445 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5446 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5447 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5448 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5449 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5450 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005451 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005452
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005453 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5454 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5455 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5456 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5457 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5458
5459 <sample_size>
5460 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5461 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5462 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5463 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5464 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5465
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005466 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5467 one of the following :
5468
5469 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5470 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5471
5472 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5473 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5474
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005475 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5476 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5477 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5478 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5479 systemd logger consumes.
5480
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005481 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5482 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5483 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5484 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005486 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5487
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005488 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5489 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5490 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5491
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005492 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5493 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5494 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5495 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005496
5497 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5498 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5499 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005500 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5501 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5502 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5503 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5504 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005505
5506 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5507
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005508 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5509 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5510 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005511
5512 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5513 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5514 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5515 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5516
5517 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5518 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005519
5520 Example :
5521 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005522 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5523 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5524 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005525 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5526 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005527 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005529
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005530log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005531 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5532 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5533 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005534
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005535 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5536 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5537 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5538 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5539 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005540
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005541 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5542 "option httplog" directives.
5543
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005544log-format-sd <string>
5545 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5546 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5547 yes | yes | yes | no
5548
5549 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5550 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5551 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5552 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5553 which covers the log format string in depth.
5554
5555 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5556 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5557
5558 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5559 log format to "rfc5424".
5560
5561 Example :
5562 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5563
5564
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005565log-tag <string>
5566 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5567 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5568 yes | yes | yes | yes
5569
5570 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5571 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5572 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5573 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5574 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5575 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5576 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5577 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5578 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005579
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005580max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5581 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5583 yes | no | yes | yes
5584
5585 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5586 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5587 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5588 servers.
5589
5590 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5591 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5592 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5593 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5594 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005595 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005596 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5597 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5598 picking a different server.
5599
5600 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5601 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5602 even if they have to be queued.
5603
5604 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5605 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5606
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005607max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5608 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5609 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5610 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005612maxconn <conns>
5613 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5615 yes | yes | yes | no
5616 Arguments :
5617 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5618 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5619 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5620 closes.
5621
5622 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5623 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5624 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5625 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005626 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5627 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5628 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5629 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005630
5631 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5632 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5633 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5634
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005635 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5636 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005638 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5639
5640
5641mode { tcp|http|health }
5642 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 yes | yes | yes | yes
5645 Arguments :
5646 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5647 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5648 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5649 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5650
5651 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5652 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5653 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5654 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5655 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5656
5657 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005658 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5659 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5660 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5661 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5662 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5663 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5664 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005665
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005666 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5667 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5668 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005669
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005670 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005671 defaults http_instances
5672 mode http
5673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005674 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005676
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005677monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005678 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005681 Arguments :
5682 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5683 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005684 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005685 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5686 backend and its backup.
5687
5688 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5689 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5690 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5691 servers in a list of backends.
5692
5693 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5694 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5695 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5696 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5697 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5698 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5699 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005700 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5701 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005702
5703 Example:
5704 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005705 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005706 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5707 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5708 monitor-uri /site_alive
5709 monitor fail if site_dead
5710
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005711 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005712
5713
5714monitor-net <source>
5715 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 yes | yes | yes | no
5718 Arguments :
5719 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5720 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5721 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5722 followed by a mask.
5723
5724 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5725 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005726 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005727 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5728
5729 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5730 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5731 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5732 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005733 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5734 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5735 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005736
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005737 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5738 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5739 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5740 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5741 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5742 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005743
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005744 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5745 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005746
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005747 Example :
5748 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5749 frontend www
5750 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5751
5752 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5753
5754
5755monitor-uri <uri>
5756 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5758 yes | yes | yes | no
5759 Arguments :
5760 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5761 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5762
5763 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5764 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5765 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5766 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5767 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5768 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5769 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5770 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5771
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005772 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005773 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5774 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5775 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5776 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5777 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5778 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005779
5780 Example :
5781 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5782 frontend www
5783 mode http
5784 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5785
5786 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005788
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005789option abortonclose
5790no option abortonclose
5791 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5793 yes | no | yes | yes
5794 Arguments : none
5795
5796 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5797 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5798 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5799 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005800 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005801 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5802 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5803 encountered while delivering the response.
5804
5805 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5806 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5807 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5808 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5809 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5810 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005811 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005812 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005813 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005814 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5815 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5816 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005818 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5819 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005820 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5821 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5822 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5823 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5824 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5825 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005826 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005827
5828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5830
5831 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5832
5833
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005834option accept-invalid-http-request
5835no option accept-invalid-http-request
5836 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5838 yes | yes | yes | no
5839 Arguments : none
5840
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005841 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005842 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005843 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005844 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5845 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5846 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5847 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5848 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005849 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5850 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5851 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5852 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005853 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005854 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005855 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5856 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5857 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005858
5859 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5860 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5861 been confirmed.
5862
5863 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5864 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005865 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5866 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005867 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5868
5869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5871
5872 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5873 stats socket.
5874
5875
5876option accept-invalid-http-response
5877no option accept-invalid-http-response
5878 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5880 yes | no | yes | yes
5881 Arguments : none
5882
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005883 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005884 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005885 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005886 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5887 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5888 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5889 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5890 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005891 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5892 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5893 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005894
5895 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5896 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5897 been confirmed.
5898
5899 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5900 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5901 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5902 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5903
5904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5906
5907 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5908 stats socket.
5909
5910
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005911option allbackups
5912no option allbackups
5913 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5915 yes | no | yes | yes
5916 Arguments : none
5917
5918 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5919 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5920 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5921 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5922 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5923 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5924 order between the backup servers anymore.
5925
5926 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5927 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5928
5929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5931
5932
5933option checkcache
5934no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005935 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5937 yes | no | yes | yes
5938 Arguments : none
5939
5940 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5941 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005942 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005943 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5944 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005945 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005946
5947 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005948 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005949 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005950 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5951 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005952 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005953 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005954 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5955 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005956 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005957 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5958 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005959 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005960 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5961 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5962 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5963 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5964 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5965 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5966 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5967 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5968 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5969
5970 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005971 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5972 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5973 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5974 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005975
5976 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5977 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005978 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005979 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005980
5981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5983
5984
5985option clitcpka
5986no option clitcpka
5987 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5989 yes | yes | yes | no
5990 Arguments : none
5991
5992 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5993 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005994 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005995 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5996
5997 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5998 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5999 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6000 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6001
6002 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6003 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6004 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6005 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6006 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6007
6008 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6009
6010 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6011 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6012 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6013
6014 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6015 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6016
6017 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6018
6019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006020option contstats
6021 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 yes | yes | yes | no
6024 Arguments : none
6025
6026 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6027 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6028 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6029 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006030 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6031 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6032 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6033 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6034 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006035
6036
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006037option dontlog-normal
6038no option dontlog-normal
6039 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6041 yes | yes | yes | no
6042 Arguments : none
6043
6044 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6045 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6046 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6047 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6048 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6049 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6050 logged.
6051
6052 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6053 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6054 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006056 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006057 logging.
6058
6059
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006060option dontlognull
6061no option dontlognull
6062 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6064 yes | yes | yes | no
6065 Arguments : none
6066
6067 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6068 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6069 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6070 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6071 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6072 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006073 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6074 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6075 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006076
6077 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006078 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006079 would not be logged.
6080
6081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6083
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006084 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6085 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006086
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006087
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006088option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006089 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6091 yes | yes | yes | yes
6092 Arguments :
6093 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6094 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006095 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006096 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006097
6098 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6099 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6100 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6101 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6102 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6103 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6104 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006105 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6106 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6107 possible that the client has already brought one.
6108
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006109 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006110 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006111 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006112 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006113 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006114 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006115
6116 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6117 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6118 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6119 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6120 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6121 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6122 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6123
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006124 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6125 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6126 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6127 are under the control of the end-user.
6128
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006129 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006130 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6131 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006132 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6133 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6134 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006135
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006136 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006137 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6138 frontend www
6139 mode http
6140 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6141
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006142 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6143 backend www
6144 mode http
6145 option forwardfor header X-Client
6146
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006147 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006148 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006149
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006150
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006151option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6152no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6153 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6155 yes | yes | yes | no
6156 Arguments : none
6157
6158 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6159 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6160 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6161 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6162 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6163 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6164 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6165
6166 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6167 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6168 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6169 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6170 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6171 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6172 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6173 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6174 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6175 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6176
6177 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6178
6179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6181
6182 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6183 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6184
6185
6186option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6187no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6188 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6190 yes | no | yes | yes
6191 Arguments : none
6192
6193 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6194 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6195 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6196 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6197 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6198 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6199 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6200
6201 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6202 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6203 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6204 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6205 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6206 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6207 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6208 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6209 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6210 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6211
6212 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6213
6214 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6215 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6216
6217 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6218 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6219
6220
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006221option http-buffer-request
6222no option http-buffer-request
6223 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6225 yes | yes | yes | yes
6226 Arguments : none
6227
6228 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6229 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6230 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6231 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6232 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6233 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6234 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6235 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006236 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006237 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6238 default.
6239
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006240 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006241
6242
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006243option http-ignore-probes
6244no option http-ignore-probes
6245 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6247 yes | yes | yes | no
6248 Arguments : none
6249
6250 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6251 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6252 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6253 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6254 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6255 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6256 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6257 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6258 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006259 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6260 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006261 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6262
6263 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6264 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6265 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6266 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6267 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6268 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6269 are often the only way to detect them.
6270
6271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6273
6274 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6275
6276
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006277option http-keep-alive
6278no option http-keep-alive
6279 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6281 yes | yes | yes | yes
6282 Arguments : none
6283
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006284 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6285 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006286 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6287 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006288 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6289 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6290 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006291
6292 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6293 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006294 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6295 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6296 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6297 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6298 situations where this option may be useful :
6299
6300 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006301 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006302
6303 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6304 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6305
6306 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6307 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6308 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6309 request.
6310
6311 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6312 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006313 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6314 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6315 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006316
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006317 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6318 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6319 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6320 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6321 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6322 not set.
6323
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006324 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6325 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6326 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006327
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006328 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006329 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006330 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006331
6332
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006333option http-no-delay
6334no option http-no-delay
6335 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6337 yes | yes | yes | yes
6338 Arguments : none
6339
6340 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6341 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6342 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6343 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6344 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6345 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6346 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6347 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6348 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6349 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6350 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6351 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6352 affected.
6353
6354 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6355 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6356 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6357 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6358 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6359 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6360 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6361 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6362 latency environments.
6363
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006364 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6365
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006366
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006367option http-pretend-keepalive
6368no option http-pretend-keepalive
6369 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006371 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006372 Arguments : none
6373
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006374 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006375 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6376 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6377 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6378 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6379 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6380 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6381 consider the response complete.
6382
6383 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6384 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6385 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6386 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006387 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006388 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6389
6390 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6391 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6392 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6393 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6394 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6395 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6396 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6397
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006398 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6399 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6400 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6401 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6402 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6403 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006404
6405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6407
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006408 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006409 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006410
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006411
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006412option http-server-close
6413no option http-server-close
6414 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6416 yes | yes | yes | yes
6417 Arguments : none
6418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006419 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6420 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6421 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6422 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006423 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6424 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6425 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6426 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6427 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6428 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6429 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6430 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6431 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6432 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6433 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006434
6435 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6436 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6437 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6438 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006439 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6440 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006441
6442 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6443 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006444 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6445 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6446 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006447
6448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006451 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6452 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006453
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006454option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006455no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006456 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6458 yes | yes | yes | no
6459 Arguments : none
6460
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006461 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006462 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6463 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6464 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6465 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6466 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6467 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6468
6469 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6470 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006471 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6472 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6473 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006474
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006475 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6476 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6477 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6478 front of an existing proxy.
6479
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006480 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6481
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006482 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006483
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006484option httpchk
6485option httpchk <uri>
6486option httpchk <method> <uri>
6487option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6488 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 yes | no | yes | yes
6491 Arguments :
6492 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6493 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6494 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6495 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6496 ones.
6497
6498 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6499 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6500 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6501
6502 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6503 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6504 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6505 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6506 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6507
6508 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6509 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6510 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6511 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6512 the lack of any response.
6513
6514 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6515
6516 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6517 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6518 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6519
6520 Examples :
6521 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6522 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6523 backend https_relay
6524 mode tcp
6525 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6526 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6527
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006528 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6529 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6530 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006531
6532
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006533option httpclose
6534no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006535 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | yes
6538 Arguments : none
6539
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006540 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6541 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6542 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6543 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006544 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006545
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006546 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6547 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006548 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006549 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6550 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006551
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006552 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6553 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6554 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006555
6556 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6557 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006558 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6559 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6560 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006561
6562 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6563 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6564
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006565 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006566
6567
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006568option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006569 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006571 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006572 Arguments :
6573 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6574 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6575 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006576 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006577 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006578
6579 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6580 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6581 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6582 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6583 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6584 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6585 ports.
6586
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006587 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6588 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006589
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006590 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006592 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006593
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006594
6595option http_proxy
6596no option http_proxy
6597 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | yes | yes | yes
6600 Arguments : none
6601
6602 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6603 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6604 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6605 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6606 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6607
6608 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6609 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006610 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6611 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006612
6613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6615
6616 Example :
6617 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6618 backend direct_forward
6619 option httpclose
6620 option http_proxy
6621
6622 See also : "option httpclose"
6623
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006624
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006625option independent-streams
6626no option independent-streams
6627 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6629 yes | yes | yes | yes
6630 Arguments : none
6631
6632 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6633 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6634 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6635 receive data or not.
6636
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006637 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006638 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6639 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6640 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6641 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6642 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6643 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6644 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6645 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6646 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6647 socket buffers.
6648
6649 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6650 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6651 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6652 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6653 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6654
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006655 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006656
6657
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006658option ldap-check
6659 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6661 yes | no | yes | yes
6662 Arguments : none
6663
6664 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6665 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6666 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6667 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6668
6669 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6670 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6671
6672 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6673 configure it.
6674
6675 Example :
6676 option ldap-check
6677
6678 See also : "option httpchk"
6679
6680
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006681option external-check
6682 Use external processes for server health checks
6683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 yes | no | yes | yes
6685
6686 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6687 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6688 command".
6689
6690 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6691
6692 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6693
6694
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006695option log-health-checks
6696no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006697 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6699 yes | no | yes | yes
6700 Arguments : none
6701
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006702 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6703 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6704 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006705
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006706 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6707 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6708 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6709 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6710 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6711
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006712 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006713 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006714
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006715 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6716 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6717 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006718
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006719
6720option log-separate-errors
6721no option log-separate-errors
6722 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6724 yes | yes | yes | no
6725 Arguments : none
6726
6727 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6728 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6729 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6730 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6731 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6732 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6733 provides very important information.
6734
6735 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6736 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6737 error logs.
6738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006739 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006740 logging.
6741
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006742
6743option logasap
6744no option logasap
6745 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6747 yes | yes | yes | no
6748 Arguments : none
6749
6750 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6751 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6752 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6753 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6754 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6755 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6756 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006757 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006758 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6759 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6760
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006761 Examples :
6762 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6763 mode http
6764 option httplog
6765 option logasap
6766 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6767
6768 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6769 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6770 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6771 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006774 logging.
6775
6776
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006777option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006778 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6780 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006781 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006782 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6783 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006784 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006785
6786 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6787 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006788 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006789 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6790 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6791 in the MySQL table, like this :
6792
6793 USE mysql;
6794 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6795 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6796
6797 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006798 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006799 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6800 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6801 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6802 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6803 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6804 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6805 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6806
6807 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6808 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006809
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006810 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006811
6812 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6813 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6814 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6815 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006816 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6817 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006818
6819 See also: "option httpchk"
6820
6821
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006822option nolinger
6823no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006824 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6826 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006827 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006828
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006829 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006830 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6831 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6832 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6833 connections.
6834
6835 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6836 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6837 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6838 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6839 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6840 this too.
6841
6842 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6843 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6844 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6845
6846 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6847 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6848 for servers.
6849
6850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6852
6853
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006854option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6855 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6857 yes | yes | yes | yes
6858 Arguments :
6859 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6860 matching <network>
6861 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6862 header name.
6863
6864 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6865 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6866 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6867 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6868 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6869 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6870 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6871 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6872 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6873 possible that the client has already brought one.
6874
6875 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6876 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6877 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6878 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6879 header and requires different one.
6880
6881 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6882 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6883 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6884 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6885 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6886 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6887 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6888
6889 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6890 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6891 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6892 both are defined.
6893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006894 Examples :
6895 # Original Destination address
6896 frontend www
6897 mode http
6898 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6899
6900 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6901 backend www
6902 mode http
6903 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6904
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006905 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006906
6907
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006908option persist
6909no option persist
6910 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006913 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006914
6915 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6916 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6917 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6918 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6919 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6920 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6921 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6922 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6923 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6924 redirected to another valid server.
6925
6926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6928
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006929 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006930
6931
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006932option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6933 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6935 yes | no | yes | yes
6936 Arguments :
6937 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6938 PostgreSQL server.
6939
6940 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6941 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6942 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6943 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6944
6945 See also: "option httpchk"
6946
6947
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006948option prefer-last-server
6949no option prefer-last-server
6950 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | no | yes | yes
6953 Arguments : none
6954
6955 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6956 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6957 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6958 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6959 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6960 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6961 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6962 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6963 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006964 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6965 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006966 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6967 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6968 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006969 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6970 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6971 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006972
6973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6975
6976 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6977
6978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006979option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006980option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006981no option redispatch
6982 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6983 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6984 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006985 Arguments :
6986 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6987 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6988 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006989 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006990 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006991 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006992 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6993 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6994 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006996
6997 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6998 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6999 be able to access the service anymore.
7000
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007001 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7002 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007003
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007004 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007005 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7006 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007008 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7009 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7010
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007011 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007012
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007013
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007014option redis-check
7015 Use redis health checks for server testing
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 yes | no | yes | yes
7018 Arguments : none
7019
7020 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7021 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7022 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7023 find the "+PONG" response message.
7024
7025 Example :
7026 option redis-check
7027
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007028 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007029
7030
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007031option smtpchk
7032option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7033 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7035 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007036 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007037 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007038 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007039 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7040
7041 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7042 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7043 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7044
7045 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7046 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7047 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7048 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7049 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7050 dead server.
7051
7052 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7053 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007054 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007055 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7056
7057 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7058 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7059 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7060 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007061 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007062
7063 Example :
7064 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7065
7066 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007069option socket-stats
7070no option socket-stats
7071
7072 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7074 yes | yes | yes | no
7075
7076 Arguments : none
7077
7078
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007079option splice-auto
7080no option splice-auto
7081 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7083 yes | yes | yes | yes
7084 Arguments : none
7085
7086 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7087 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007088 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007089 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007090 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007091 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7092 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7093 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7094 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7095
7096 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7097 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7098 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7099 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7100 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7101 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7102 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7103 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7104 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7105 keyword.
7106
7107 Example :
7108 option splice-auto
7109
7110 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7111 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7112
7113 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7114 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7115
7116
7117option splice-request
7118no option splice-request
7119 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7121 yes | yes | yes | yes
7122 Arguments : none
7123
7124 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007125 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007126 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7127 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7128 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7129 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7130
7131 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7132
7133 Example :
7134 option splice-request
7135
7136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7138
7139 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7140 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7141
7142
7143option splice-response
7144no option splice-response
7145 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | yes | yes | yes
7148 Arguments : none
7149
7150 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007151 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007152 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7153 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7154 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7155 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7156
7157 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7158
7159 Example :
7160 option splice-response
7161
7162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7164
7165 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7166 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7167
7168
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007169option spop-check
7170 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7172 no | no | no | yes
7173 Arguments : none
7174
7175 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7176 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7177 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7178 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7179
7180 Example :
7181 option spop-check
7182
7183 See also : "option httpchk"
7184
7185
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007186option srvtcpka
7187no option srvtcpka
7188 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 yes | no | yes | yes
7191 Arguments : none
7192
7193 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7194 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007195 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007196 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7197
7198 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7199 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7200 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7201 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7202
7203 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7204 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7205 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7206 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7207 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7208
7209 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7210
7211 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7212 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7213 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7214
7215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7217
7218 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7219
7220
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007221option ssl-hello-chk
7222 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 yes | no | yes | yes
7225 Arguments : none
7226
7227 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7228 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7229 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7230 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7231 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7232 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7233 hello message.
7234
7235 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7236 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7237 messages, which is appreciable.
7238
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007239 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7240 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7241 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007242
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007243 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7244
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007245
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007246option tcp-check
7247 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7249 yes | no | yes | yes
7250
7251 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7252 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7253
7254 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7255 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7256 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7257
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007258 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007259 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7260 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7261 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7262 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7263 only.
7264
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007265 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007266 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7267 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7268 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7269 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7270
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007271 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007272 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7273 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007274 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007275 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7276 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7277 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7278 the respective protocols.
7279 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007280 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007281
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007282 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7283 script.
7284
7285 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7286 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7287 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7288 The "comment" is of course optional.
7289
7290
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007291 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007292 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007293 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007294 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007295
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007296 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007297 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007298 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007299
7300 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7301 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007302 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007303 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007304 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007305 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007306 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007307 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007308 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7309 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007310 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007311 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7312 tcp-check expect string +OK
7313
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007314 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007315 (send many headers before analyzing)
7316 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007317 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007318 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7319 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7320 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7321 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007322 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007323
7324
7325 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7326
7327
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007328option tcp-smart-accept
7329no option tcp-smart-accept
7330 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7332 yes | yes | yes | no
7333 Arguments : none
7334
7335 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7336 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7337 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7338 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7339 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7340 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7341
7342 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7343 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7344 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7345 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7346
7347 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7348 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7349 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007350 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007351
7352 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7353 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7354 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7355
7356 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7357 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7358 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7359
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007360 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7361
7362
7363option tcp-smart-connect
7364no option tcp-smart-connect
7365 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7367 yes | no | yes | yes
7368 Arguments : none
7369
7370 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7371 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7372 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7373 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7374 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7375
7376 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7377 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7378 complex.
7379
7380 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7381 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7382 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7383
7384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7386
7387 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7388
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007389
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007390option tcpka
7391 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7393 yes | yes | yes | yes
7394 Arguments : none
7395
7396 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7397 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007398 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007399 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7400
7401 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7402 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7403 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7404 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7405
7406 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7407 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7408 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7409 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7410 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7411
7412 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7413
7414 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7415 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7416 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7417 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7418 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7419 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7420 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7421 backends.
7422
7423 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7424
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007425
7426option tcplog
7427 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007429 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007430 Arguments : none
7431
7432 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7433 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7434 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7435 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7436 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7437 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7438 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7439 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7440
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007441 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007443 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007444
7445
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007446option transparent
7447no option transparent
7448 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007450 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007451 Arguments : none
7452
7453 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7454 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7455 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7456 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7457 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7458 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7459 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7460 appropriate server.
7461
7462 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7463 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7464
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007465 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007466 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007467
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007468
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007469external-check command <command>
7470 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 yes | no | yes | yes
7473
7474 Arguments :
7475 <command> is the external command to run
7476
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007477 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7478
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007479 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007480
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007481 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7482 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7483 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7484 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7485 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7486 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007487
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007488 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7489
7490 Environment variables :
7491 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7492 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7493
7494 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7495
7496 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7497
7498 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7499 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7500 for a UNIX socket).
7501
7502 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7503
7504 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7505
7506 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7507
7508 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7509
7510 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7511
7512 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7513 socket).
7514
7515 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7516 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7517
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007518 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7519
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007520 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7521 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7522 failed.
7523
7524 Example :
7525 external-check command /bin/true
7526
7527 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7528
7529
7530external-check path <path>
7531 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7533 yes | no | yes | yes
7534
7535 Arguments :
7536 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7537
7538 The default path is "".
7539
7540 Example :
7541 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7542
7543 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7544 "external-check command"
7545
7546
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007547persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007548persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007549 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
7552 Arguments :
7553 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007554 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7555 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007556
7557 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7558 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007559 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007560 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7561 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7562 forwarded to this server.
7563
7564 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7565 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7566 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007567 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007568 a single "listen" section.
7569
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007570 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7571 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7572 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7573
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007574 Example :
7575 listen tse-farm
7576 bind :3389
7577 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7578 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7579 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7580 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7581 persist rdp-cookie
7582 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007583 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007584 balance rdp-cookie
7585 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7586 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7587
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007588 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7589 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007590
7591
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007592rate-limit sessions <rate>
7593 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7595 yes | yes | yes | no
7596 Arguments :
7597 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7598 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7599
7600 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7601 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7602 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7603 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7604 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7605 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7606
7607 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7608 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7609 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7610 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7611
7612 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7613 listen smtp
7614 mode tcp
7615 bind :25
7616 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007617 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007618
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007619 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7620 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7621 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007622
7623 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7624
7625
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007626redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7627redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7628redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007629 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7631 no | yes | yes | yes
7632
7633 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007634 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007635
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007636 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007637 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007638 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7639 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7640 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007641
7642 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7643 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7644 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7645 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7646 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007647 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7648 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7649 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7650 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007651
7652 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7653 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7654 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7655 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7656 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7657 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007658 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007659 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007660 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7661 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7662 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007663
7664 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007665 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7666 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7667 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007668 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007669 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7670 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7671 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7672 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007673
7674 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007675 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007676
7677 - "drop-query"
7678 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7679 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7680 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7681 with a location-type redirect.
7682
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007683 - "append-slash"
7684 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7685 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7686 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7687 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7688
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007689 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7690 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7691 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7692 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7693 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7694 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7695 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7696
7697 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7698 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7699 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7700 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7701 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7702 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7703 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007704
7705 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7706 acl clear dst_port 80
7707 acl secure dst_port 8080
7708 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007709 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007710 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007711 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7712
7713 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007714 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7715 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7716 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007717 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007718
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007719 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7720 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7721 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7722
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007723 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007724 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007725
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007726 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007727 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7728 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7729 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007731 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007732
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007733
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007734retries <value>
7735 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7736 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7737 yes | no | yes | yes
7738 Arguments :
7739 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7740 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7741 default value is 3.
7742
7743 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7744 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7745 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7746
7747 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007748 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7749 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007750
7751 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7752 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7753
7754 See also : "option redispatch"
7755
7756
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007757retry-on [list of keywords]
7758 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 yes | no | yes | yes
7761 Arguments :
7762 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7763 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7764 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7765 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7766
7767 none never retry
7768
7769 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7770 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7771
7772 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7773 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7774 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7775 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7776 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7777 processing the request.
7778
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007779 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7780 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7781 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7782 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7783 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7784 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7785 overflow attack for example).
7786
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007787 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7788 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7789 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7790 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7791 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7792 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7793 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7794 amplify denial of service attacks.
7795
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007796 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7797 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7798 considered to be safe to retry.
7799
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007800 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7801 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7802 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7803 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7804
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007805 all-retryable-errors
7806 retry request for any error that are considered
7807 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7808 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7809 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7810
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007811 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7812 not cumulative.
7813
7814 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7815 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7816 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7817 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7818
7819 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7820 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7821 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7822 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7823 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7824 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7825 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7826 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7827 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7828 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7829 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7830 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7831
7832 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7833 should not use this directive.
7834
7835 The default is "conn-failure".
7836
7837 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7838
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007839server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007840 Declare a server in a backend
7841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7842 no | no | yes | yes
7843 Arguments :
7844 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007845 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007846 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007847
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007848 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7849 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7850 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7851 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007852 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7853 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7854 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7855 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7856 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007857 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7858 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7859 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7860 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7861 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7862 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7863 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007864 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007865 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7866 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7867 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7868 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7869 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7870 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007871 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7872 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007873 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7874 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007876 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007877 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7878 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7879 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7880 adding this value to the client's port.
7881
7882 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7883 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007884 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007885
7886 Examples :
7887 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7888 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007889 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007890 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7891 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7892 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007893
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007894 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7895 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7896 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7897 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7898 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7899
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007900 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7901 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007902
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007903server-state-file-name [<file>]
7904 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7905 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7906 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7907 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7908 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7909 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7910
7911 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7912 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7913
7914 global
7915 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7916
7917 backend bk
7918 load-server-state-from-file
7919
7920 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7921 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007922
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007923server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7924 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7925 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 no | no | yes | yes
7928
7929 Arguments:
7930 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7931
7932 <num | range>
7933 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7934 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7935 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7936 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7937
7938 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7939
7940 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7941
7942 <params*>
7943 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7944 keyword.
7945
7946 Examples:
7947 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7948 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7949 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7950
7951 # or
7952 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7953
7954 # would be equivalent to:
7955 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7956 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7957 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7958
7959
7960
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007961source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007962source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007963source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007964 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7966 yes | no | yes | yes
7967 Arguments :
7968 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7969 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007970
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007971 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007972 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7973 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7974 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7975 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7976 supported prefixes are :
7977 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7978 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7979 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007980 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007981 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7982 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007983
7984 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7985 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007986 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7987 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7988 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007989
7990 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7991 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7992 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7993 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7994 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7995 <addr>.
7996
7997 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7998 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7999 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8000 port.
8001
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008002 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8003 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8004 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8005 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008006 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008007 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8008 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8009 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8010 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8011 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8012 HTTP header.
8013
8014 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8015 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008016 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008017 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8018 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8019 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8020 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8021 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8022 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8023 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8024
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008025 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8026 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8027 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8028 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8029 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8030 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8031
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008032 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8033 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8034 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8035 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8036
8037 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8038 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8039 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8040 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8041 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8042 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8043
8044 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8045 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8046 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8047 there are two methods :
8048
8049 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8050 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8051 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8052 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8053 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8054 of the client ranges may be used.
8055
8056 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8057 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8058 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8059 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8060 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8061 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8062 same session.
8063
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008064 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8065 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8066 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008067 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008068
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008069 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8070
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008071 Examples :
8072 backend private
8073 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8074 source 192.168.1.200
8075
8076 backend transparent_ssl1
8077 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8078 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8079
8080 backend transparent_ssl2
8081 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8082 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8083 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8084
8085 backend transparent_ssl3
8086 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8087 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8088 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8089
8090 backend transparent_smtp
8091 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8092 # with Tproxy version 4.
8093 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8094
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008095 backend transparent_http
8096 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8097 # proxy.
8098 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008100 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008103
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008104stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8105 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008107 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008108
8109 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8110 matched.
8111
8112 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8113 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8114
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008115 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8116 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008117 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008118
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008119 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8120 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8121 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8122 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008123
8124 Example :
8125 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8126 backend stats_localhost
8127 stats enable
8128 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8129
8130 Example :
8131 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8132 backend stats_auth
8133 stats enable
8134 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8135 stats admin if TRUE
8136
8137 Example :
8138 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8139 userlist stats-auth
8140 group admin users admin
8141 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8142 group readonly users haproxy
8143 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8144
8145 backend stats_auth
8146 stats enable
8147 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8148 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8149 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8150 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8151
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008152 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8153 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8154 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008155
8156
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008157stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8158 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008160 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008161 Arguments :
8162 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8163
8164 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8165
8166 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8167 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8168 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8169 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8170 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8171 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8172
8173 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8174 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8175 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008176 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008177
8178 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8179 report using "stats scope".
8180
8181 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8182 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8183 unobvious parameters.
8184
8185 Example :
8186 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8187 backend public_www
8188 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8189 stats enable
8190 stats hide-version
8191 stats scope .
8192 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008193 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8195 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8196
8197 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8198 backend private_monitoring
8199 stats enable
8200 stats uri /admin?stats
8201 stats refresh 5s
8202
8203 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8204
8205
8206stats enable
8207 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008209 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008210 Arguments : none
8211
8212 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8213 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8214 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8215 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8216 - stats auth : no authentication
8217 - stats scope : no restriction
8218
8219 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8220 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8221 unobvious parameters.
8222
8223 Example :
8224 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8225 backend public_www
8226 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8227 stats enable
8228 stats hide-version
8229 stats scope .
8230 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008231 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008232 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8233 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8234
8235 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8236 backend private_monitoring
8237 stats enable
8238 stats uri /admin?stats
8239 stats refresh 5s
8240
8241 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8242
8243
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008244stats hide-version
8245 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008247 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008248 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008249
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008250 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8251 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8252 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8253 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8254 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8255 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008257 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8258 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8259 unobvious parameters.
8260
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008261 Example :
8262 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8263 backend public_www
8264 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008265 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008266 stats hide-version
8267 stats scope .
8268 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008269 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008270 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8271 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008272
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008273 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8274 backend private_monitoring
8275 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008276 stats uri /admin?stats
8277 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008279 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008280
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008281
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008282stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8283 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8284 Access control for statistics
8285
8286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8287 no | no | yes | yes
8288
8289 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8290 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8291 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8292 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8293 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8294 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8295
8296 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8297 instance.
8298
8299 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8300 about ACL usage.
8301
8302
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008303stats realm <realm>
8304 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008306 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008307 Arguments :
8308 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8309 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8310 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8311
8312 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8313 using a backslash ('\').
8314
8315 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8316 only related to authentication.
8317
8318 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8319 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8320 unobvious parameters.
8321
8322 Example :
8323 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8324 backend public_www
8325 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8326 stats enable
8327 stats hide-version
8328 stats scope .
8329 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008331 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8332 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8333
8334 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8335 backend private_monitoring
8336 stats enable
8337 stats uri /admin?stats
8338 stats refresh 5s
8339
8340 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8341
8342
8343stats refresh <delay>
8344 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008347 Arguments :
8348 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8349 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8350 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8351 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8352 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8353 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8354
8355 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8356 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8357 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8358 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8359
8360 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8361 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8362 unobvious parameters.
8363
8364 Example :
8365 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8366 backend public_www
8367 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8368 stats enable
8369 stats hide-version
8370 stats scope .
8371 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008372 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008373 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8374 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8375
8376 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8377 backend private_monitoring
8378 stats enable
8379 stats uri /admin?stats
8380 stats refresh 5s
8381
8382 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8383
8384
8385stats scope { <name> | "." }
8386 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008389 Arguments :
8390 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8391 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8392 section in which the statement appears.
8393
8394 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8395 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8396 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8397 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8398 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8399 exists.
8400
8401 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8402 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8403 unobvious parameters.
8404
8405 Example :
8406 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8407 backend public_www
8408 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8409 stats enable
8410 stats hide-version
8411 stats scope .
8412 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008413 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008414 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8415 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8416
8417 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8418 backend private_monitoring
8419 stats enable
8420 stats uri /admin?stats
8421 stats refresh 5s
8422
8423 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8424
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008425
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008426stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008427 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008429 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008430
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008431 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008432 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8433
8434 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8435 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8436
8437 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8438 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008440
8441 Example :
8442 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8443 backend private_monitoring
8444 stats enable
8445 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8446 stats uri /admin?stats
8447 stats refresh 5s
8448
8449 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8450 global section.
8451
8452
8453stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008454 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8456 yes | yes | yes | yes
8457 Arguments : none
8458
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008459 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008460 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8461 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8462 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8463 - IP (socket, server)
8464 - cookie (backend, server)
8465
8466 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8467 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008468 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008469
8470 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8471
8472
8473stats show-node [ <name> ]
8474 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008476 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008477 Arguments:
8478 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8479 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8480
8481 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8482 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008483 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008484
8485 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8486 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8487 unobvious parameters.
8488
8489 Example:
8490 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8491 backend private_monitoring
8492 stats enable
8493 stats show-node Europe-1
8494 stats uri /admin?stats
8495 stats refresh 5s
8496
8497 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8498 section.
8499
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008500
8501stats uri <prefix>
8502 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008504 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008505 Arguments :
8506 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8507 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8508 query string.
8509
8510 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8511 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8512 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8513 possible to reach it in the application.
8514
8515 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008516 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008517 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8518 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8519 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8520 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8521
8522 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8523 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8524 an address or a port to statistics only.
8525
8526 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8527 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8528 unobvious parameters.
8529
8530 Example :
8531 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8532 backend public_www
8533 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8534 stats enable
8535 stats hide-version
8536 stats scope .
8537 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008538 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008539 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8540 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8541
8542 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8543 backend private_monitoring
8544 stats enable
8545 stats uri /admin?stats
8546 stats refresh 5s
8547
8548 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8549
8550
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008551stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8552 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008554 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008555
8556 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008557 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008558 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008560 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8561
8562 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8563 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8564 the "stick-table" statement.
8565
8566 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8567 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8568 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8569 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8570 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8571
8572 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8573 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8574 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8575 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8576 transformation rules.
8577
8578 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8579 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8580 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8581 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8582 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8583 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8584 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8585
8586 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8587 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8588 ACL based conditions.
8589
8590 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8591 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8592 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8593 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8594
8595 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8596 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8597 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8598 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8599
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008600 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8601 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008602 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008603
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008604 Example :
8605 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8606 # last 30 minutes
8607 backend pop
8608 mode tcp
8609 balance roundrobin
8610 stick store-request src
8611 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8612 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8613 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8614
8615 backend smtp
8616 mode tcp
8617 balance roundrobin
8618 stick match src table pop
8619 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8620 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8621
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008622 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008623 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008624
8625
8626stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8627 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8629 no | no | yes | yes
8630
8631 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8632 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8633 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8634 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8635
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008636 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8637 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008638 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008639
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008640 Examples :
8641 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008642 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008643
8644 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8645 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8646 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8647
8648
8649 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8650 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8651 backend http
8652 mode http
8653 balance roundrobin
8654 stick on src table https
8655 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8656 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8657 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8658
8659 backend https
8660 mode tcp
8661 balance roundrobin
8662 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8663 stick on src
8664 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8665 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8666
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008667 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008668
8669
8670stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8671 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 no | no | yes | yes
8674
8675 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008676 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008677 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008678 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008679 server is selected.
8680
8681 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8682 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8683 the "stick-table" statement.
8684
8685 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8686 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8687 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8688 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8689 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8690 address.
8691
8692 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8693 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8694 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8695 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8696 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8697 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8698 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8699 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8700 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8701 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8702
8703 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8704 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8705 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8706 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8707 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8708 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8709 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8710
8711 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8712 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8713 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8714 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8715
8716 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8717 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8718 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8719 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8720 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8721 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008722 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8723 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8724 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8725 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8726 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8727 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008728
8729 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8730 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8731 the request.
8732
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008733 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8734 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008735 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008736
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008737 Example :
8738 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8739 # last 30 minutes
8740 backend pop
8741 mode tcp
8742 balance roundrobin
8743 stick store-request src
8744 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8745 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8746 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8747
8748 backend smtp
8749 mode tcp
8750 balance roundrobin
8751 stick match src table pop
8752 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8753 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8754
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008755 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008756 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008757
8758
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008759stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008760 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8761 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008762 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008764 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008765
8766 Arguments :
8767 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8768 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8769 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8770 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8771
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008772 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8773 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8774 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8775 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8776
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008777 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8778 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8779 instance.
8780
8781 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8782 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8783 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8784 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8785 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8786 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008787 to 32 characters.
8788
8789 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8790 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8791 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008792 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008793 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8794 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795
8796 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008797 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8798 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008799 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8800 increase.
8801
8802 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008803 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8804 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8805 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008806
8807 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8808 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8809 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8810 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008811 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008812 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8813 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8814 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8815 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8816 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8817 parameter (see below).
8818
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008819 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8820 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8821 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8822 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8823 soft restart.
8824
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008825 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8826 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008827
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008828 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8829 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8830 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8831 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008832 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008833 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008834 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8835 if not expiration delay is specified.
8836
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008837 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8838 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8839 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8840 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008841 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8842 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8843 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8844 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8845 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8846 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8847 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8848 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8849 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8850 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8851 types and their arguments.
8852
8853 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8854 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8855 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8856 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8857
8858 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8859 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8860 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008861 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008862
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008863 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8864 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8865 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008866 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008867 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008868 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008869
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008870 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8871 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8872 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8873 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8874
8875 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8876 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8877 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8878 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8879 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8880 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8881
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008882 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8883 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8884 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8885 they were received.
8886
8887 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8888 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8889 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8890 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8891 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8892
8893 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8894 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8895 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8896 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8897 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8898
8899 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8900 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8901 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8902
8903 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8904 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8905 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8906 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8907 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8908
8909 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8910 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8911 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8912 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8913 the client side.
8914
8915 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8916 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8917 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8918 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8919 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8920 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8921 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8922
8923 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8924 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8925 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8926 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8927 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8928 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008929 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008930
8931 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8932 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8933 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8934 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8935 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8936 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8937
8938 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008939 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008940 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8941 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8942
8943 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8944 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8945 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8946 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8947 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8948 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8949 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8950 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8951 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8952 recommended for better fairness.
8953
8954 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008955 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008956 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8957 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8958
8959 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8960 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8961 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8962 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8963 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8964 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8965 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8966 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8967 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8968 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008969
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008970 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8971 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008972 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8973 reference it.
8974
8975 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8976 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008977 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8978 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8979 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008980
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008981 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8982 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8983 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8984 something that can be ignored.
8985
8986 Example:
8987 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8988 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8989 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8990 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8991
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008992 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008993 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008994
8995
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008996stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008997 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8999 no | no | yes | yes
9000
9001 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009002 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009003 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009004 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009005 server is selected.
9006
9007 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9008 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9009 the "stick-table" statement.
9010
9011 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9012 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9013 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9014 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9015
9016 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9017 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9018 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9019 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9020 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9021 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009022 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009023 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9024 rules.
9025
9026 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9027 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9028 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9029 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9030 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9031 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9032 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9033
9034 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9035 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9036 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9037 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9038
9039 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9040 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9041 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9042 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9043 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9044 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009045 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9046 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9047 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9048 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9049 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9050 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9051 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9052 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9053 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009054
9055 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9056
9057 Example :
9058 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9059 backend https
9060 mode tcp
9061 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009062 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009063 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009064
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009065 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9066 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9067
9068 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9069 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9070 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9071
9072 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9073 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009074
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009075 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9076 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9077 # at offset 44.
9078
9079 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9080 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9081
9082 # Learn on response if server hello.
9083 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009084
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009085 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9086 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9087
9088 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9089 extraction.
9090
9091
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009092tcp-check connect [params*]
9093 Opens a new connection
9094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9095 no | no | yes | yes
9096
9097 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9098 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9099 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9100
9101 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9102 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9103 of the sequence.
9104
9105 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9106 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9107 do.
9108
9109 Parameters :
9110 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9111 use the TCP connection.
9112
9113 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9114 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9115 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9116
9117 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9118
9119 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9120
9121 Examples:
9122 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9123 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9124 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9125 option tcp-check
9126 tcp-check connect
9127 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9128 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9129 tcp-check send \r\n
9130 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9131 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9132 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9133 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9134 tcp-check send \r\n
9135 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9136 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9137
9138 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9139 option tcp-check
9140 tcp-check connect port 110
9141 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9142 tcp-check connect port 143
9143 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9144 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9145
9146 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9147
9148
9149tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009150 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9152 no | no | yes | yes
9153
9154 Arguments :
9155 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9156 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9157 binary.
9158 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9159 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9160 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9161
9162 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9163 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9164 with the usual backslash ('\').
9165 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009166 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009167 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9168 used upper or lower case.
9169
9170
9171 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9172
9173 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9174 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9175 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9176 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9177 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9178 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9179 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9180 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9181
9182 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9183 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9184 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9185 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9186 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9187 expression.
9188
9189 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9190 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9191 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9192 this exact hexadecimal string.
9193 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9194
9195 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9196 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9197 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9198 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9199 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9200 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9201 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9202 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9203 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9204 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9205 the null character.
9206
9207 Examples :
9208 # perform a POP check
9209 option tcp-check
9210 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9211
9212 # perform an IMAP check
9213 option tcp-check
9214 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9215
9216 # look for the redis master server
9217 option tcp-check
9218 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009219 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009220 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9221 tcp-check expect string role:master
9222 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9223 tcp-check expect string +OK
9224
9225
9226 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9227 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9228
9229
9230tcp-check send <data>
9231 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 no | no | yes | yes
9234
9235 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9236 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9237
9238 Examples :
9239 # look for the redis master server
9240 option tcp-check
9241 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9242 tcp-check expect string role:master
9243
9244 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9245 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9246
9247
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009248tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9249 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009250 tcp health check
9251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9252 no | no | yes | yes
9253
9254 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9255 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009256 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009257 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9258 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9259 hexadecimal string.
9260 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9261
9262 Examples :
9263 # redis check in binary
9264 option tcp-check
9265 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9266 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9267
9268
9269 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9270 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9271
9272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009273tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9274 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9276 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009277 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009278 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9279 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009281 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009282
9283 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9284 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009285 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9286 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9287 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9288 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9289 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9290 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009292 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9293 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9294 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9295 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009296
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009297 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009298 - accept :
9299 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9300 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9301 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009303 - reject :
9304 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9305 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9306 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9307 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9308 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9309 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9310 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9311 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9312 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9313 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9314 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009315 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009316
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009317 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9318 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9319 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9320 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9321 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9322 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9323 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9324 hosts.
9325
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009326 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9327 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9328 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9329 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9330 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9331 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9332 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9333 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9334
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009335 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9336 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9337 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9338 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9339 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9340 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9341 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9342 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9343 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009344 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9345 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009346
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009347 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009348 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009349 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9350 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9351 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009352 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009353 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9354 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9355 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9356 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9357 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9358 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9359 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9360 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009362 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009363 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009364 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009365 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009366 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9367 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9368 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009370 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9371 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9372 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9373 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009375 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9376 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9377 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9378 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9379 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009380 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9381 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9382 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9383 layer7 information is extracted.
9384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009385 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9386 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9387 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9388 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9389 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009390
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009391 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9392 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9393 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9394 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9395
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009396 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9397 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9398 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9399 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9400
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009401 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9402 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9403 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9404 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9405 continues.
9406
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009407 - set-src <expr> :
9408 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9409 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9410 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009411 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009413 Arguments:
9414 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9415 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009416
9417 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009418 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9419
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009420 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9421 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009422
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009423 - set-src-port <expr> :
9424 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9425 expression.
9426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009427 Arguments:
9428 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9429 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009430
9431 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009432 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9433
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009434 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9435 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9436 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009437
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009438 - set-dst <expr> :
9439 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9440 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9441 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9442 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9443 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9444
9445 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9446 followed by some converters.
9447
9448 Example:
9449
9450 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9451 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9452
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009453 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9454 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9455
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009456 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9457 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9458 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9459 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9460
9461
9462 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9463 followed by some converters.
9464
9465 Example:
9466
9467 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9468
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009469 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9470 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9471 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9472
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009473 - "silent-drop" :
9474 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009475 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009476 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9477 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9478 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9479 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9480 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009481 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9482 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009483 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9484 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009485 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009486 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9487 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9488 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9489 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9492 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9493 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009494
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009495 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9496 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9497 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009500 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009501 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009502
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009503 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9504 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9505 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009507 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009508 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9509 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009510
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009511 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9512
9513 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9514
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9516
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009517 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009518
9519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009520tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9521 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009523 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009524 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009525 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9526 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009528 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009529
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009530 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009531 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9532 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9533 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9534 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009536 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9537 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9538 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9539 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009540 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9541 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9542 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9543 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9544 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9545 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009546 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009547 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009549 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9550 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9551 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9552 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009553
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009554 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009555 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009556 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009557 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9558 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009559 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009560 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009561 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009562 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009563 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009564 - set-dst <expr>
9565 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009566 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009567 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009568 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009569 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009571 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9572 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009573 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9574 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009575
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009576 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9577 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9578 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9579 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9580 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9581 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009583 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9585 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009586
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009587 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009588 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9589 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9590 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9591 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009592 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9593 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9594 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009595
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009596 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009597 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9598 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9599 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009600
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009601 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9602 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9603
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009604 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009605 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9606 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009607
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009608 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9609 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009610 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009611 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9612 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009613 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009614 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009615 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009616 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9617 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009619 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9620 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009621
9622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9623 followed by some converters.
9624
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009625 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9626 <var-name>.
9627
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009628 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9629 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9630 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9631 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9632 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9633
9634 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9635 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9636 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9637 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9638 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9639 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9640 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9641 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9642 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9643 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9644 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9645
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009646 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9647 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9648 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9649 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9650 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9651
9652 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9653
9654 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9655
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009656 Example:
9657
9658 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009659 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009660
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009661 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009662 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9663 # and reject everything else.
9664 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9665 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009666 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009667 tcp-request content reject
9668
9669 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009670 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9671 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9672 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009673 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009674
9675 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9676 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9677 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009678 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009679 tcp-request content reject
9680
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009681 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009682 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009683 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009684 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009685 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9686 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009687
9688 Example:
9689 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9690 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009691 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009693 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009694 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009695
9696 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009697 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009698 # protecting all our sites
9699 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009700 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9701 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009702 ...
9703 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9704
9705 backend http_dynamic
9706 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009707 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009708 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009709 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009710 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009711 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009712 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009714 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009715
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009716 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9717 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009718
9719
9720tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9721 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009723 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009724 Arguments :
9725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9727 as explained at the top of this document.
9728
9729 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9730 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9731 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9732 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9733 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9734
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009735 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9736 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9737 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9738 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9739
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009740 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9741 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009742 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009743 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009744 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9745 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9746 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9747 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009748
9749 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9750 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9751 it pass through unaffected.
9752
9753 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9754 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9755 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009756 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009757 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9758 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009759 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9760 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9761 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009762
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009763 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009764 "timeout client".
9765
9766
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009767tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9768 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9770 no | no | yes | yes
9771 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009772 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9773 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009774
9775 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009777 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009778 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9779 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009780 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9781 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009782
9783 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9784
9785 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9786 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9787 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9788 inserted.
9789
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009790 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009791 - accept :
9792 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9793 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9794 the rules evaluation.
9795
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009796 - close :
9797 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9798 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9799 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9800 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9801 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9802 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009803 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009804 protocols.
9805
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009806 - reject :
9807 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9808 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009809 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009810
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009811 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9812 Sets a variable.
9813
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009814 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9815 Unsets a variable.
9816
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009817 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9818 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9819 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9820 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9821
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009822 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9823 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9824 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9825 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9826
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009827 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9828 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9829 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9830 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9831 continues.
9832
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009833 - "silent-drop" :
9834 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009836 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9837 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9838 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9839 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9840 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009841 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9842 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009843 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9844 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009845 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009846 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9847 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9848 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9849 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9850
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009851 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9852 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9853
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009854 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9855 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9856 for changing the default action to a reject.
9857
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009858 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9859 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9860 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9861 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009862 period.
9863
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009864 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9865 declared inline.
9866
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009867 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9868 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009869 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009870 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9871 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009872 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009873 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009874 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009875 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9876 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009877 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009878 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9879 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009880
9881 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9882 followed by some converters.
9883
9884 Example:
9885
9886 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9887
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009888 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9889 <var-name>.
9890
9891 Example:
9892
9893 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9894
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009895 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9896 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9897 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9898 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9899 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9900
9901 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9902
9903 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9904
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009905 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9906
9907 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9908
9909
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009910tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9911 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9913 no | yes | yes | no
9914 Arguments :
9915 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9916 below.
9917
9918 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9919
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009920 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009921 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9922 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9923 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9924 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9925 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9926 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9927 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009928 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009929 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9930 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9931 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9932 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9933 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9934 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9935 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9936 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9937 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9938 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9939 instead.
9940
9941 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9942 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9943 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9944 rules which may be inserted.
9945
9946 Several types of actions are supported :
9947 - accept : the request is accepted
9948 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9949 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9950 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009951 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009952 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9953 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009954 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009955 - silent-drop
9956
9957 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9958 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9959 sections for a complete description.
9960
9961 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9962 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9963 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9964
9965 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9966 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9967 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9968 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9969 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9970
9971 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9972 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9973
9974 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9975 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9976 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9977
9978 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9979 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9980 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9981
9982 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9983 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9984 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9985
9986 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9987 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9988 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9989
9990 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9991
9992 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9993
9994
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009995tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9996 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9998 no | no | yes | yes
9999 Arguments :
10000 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10001 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10002 as explained at the top of this document.
10003
10004 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10005
10006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010007timeout check <timeout>
10008 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10009 established.
10010
10011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10012 yes | no | yes | yes
10013 Arguments:
10014 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10016 as explained at the top of this document.
10017
10018 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10019 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010020 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010021 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010022 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10023 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10024 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010025
10026 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10027 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10028
10029 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10030 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010031 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010032
10033 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10034 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10035 forget about it.
10036
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010037 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10038 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010039
10040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010041timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010042 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10044 yes | yes | yes | no
10045 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010046 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10048 as explained at the top of this document.
10049
10050 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10051 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10052 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010053 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10054 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10055 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10056 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010057 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10058 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10059 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010060 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010061 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010062 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10063 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010064 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10065 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010066
10067 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10068 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10069 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10070 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010071 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010072 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10073
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010074 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010075
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010076 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010078
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010079timeout client-fin <timeout>
10080 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10082 yes | yes | yes | no
10083 Arguments :
10084 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10086 as explained at the top of this document.
10087
10088 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10089 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10090 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10091 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10092 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10093 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10094 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010095 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10096 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10097 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010098
10099 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10100 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10101 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10102
10103 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10104
10105
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010106timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010107 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10109 yes | no | yes | yes
10110 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010111 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010112 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10113 as explained at the top of this document.
10114
10115 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010116 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010117 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010119 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10120 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010121
10122 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10123 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10124 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10125 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010126 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010127 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10128
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010129 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010130
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010131
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010132timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10133 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10135 yes | yes | yes | yes
10136 Arguments :
10137 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10138 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10139 as explained at the top of this document.
10140
10141 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10142 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10143 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10144 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10145 once the request has started to present itself.
10146
10147 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10148 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10149 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10150 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10151 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10152
10153 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10154 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10155 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10156 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10157
10158 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10159 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010160 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010161 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10162 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010163 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010164
10165 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10166 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10167 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10168 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010170 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10171 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010172 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10173
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010174 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10175
10176
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010177timeout http-request <timeout>
10178 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010180 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010181 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010182 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010183 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10184 as explained at the top of this document.
10185
10186 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10187 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10188 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10189 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10190 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10191 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10192 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010193 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10194 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10195 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10196 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010197 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010198 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10199 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010200
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010201 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10202 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10203 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10204 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10205 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010206 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010207
10208 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10209 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010210 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010211 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10212 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10213
10214 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010215 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10216 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10217 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010218
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010219 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010220 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010221
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010222
10223timeout queue <timeout>
10224 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10226 yes | no | yes | yes
10227 Arguments :
10228 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10229 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10230 as explained at the top of this document.
10231
10232 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10233 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10234 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10235 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10236 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10237
10238 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10239 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10240 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10241 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10242
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010243 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010244
10245
10246timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010247 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10249 yes | no | yes | yes
10250 Arguments :
10251 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10252 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10253 as explained at the top of this document.
10254
10255 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10256 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10257 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10258 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10259 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10260 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10261 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10262
10263 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10264 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10265 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10266 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10267 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010268 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010269 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010270 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10271 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010272 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10273 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010274
10275 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10276 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10277 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10278 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010279 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010280 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10281
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010282 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010283
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010284
10285timeout server-fin <timeout>
10286 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10288 yes | no | yes | yes
10289 Arguments :
10290 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10291 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10292 as explained at the top of this document.
10293
10294 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10295 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10296 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10297 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10298 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10299 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10300 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10301 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10302 situations, it should not be needed.
10303
10304 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10305 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10306 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10307
10308 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10309
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010310
10311timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010312 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10314 yes | yes | yes | yes
10315 Arguments :
10316 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10317 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10318 as explained at the top of this document.
10319
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010320 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10321 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10322 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010323
10324 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10325 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10326 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10327 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010328 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010329
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010330 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010331
10332
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010333timeout tunnel <timeout>
10334 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10336 yes | no | yes | yes
10337 Arguments :
10338 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10339 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10340 as explained at the top of this document.
10341
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010342 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010343 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10344 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10345 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010346 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10347 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010348 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10349 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10350 specified.
10351
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010352 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10353 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10354 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10355 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10356 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10357 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10358 state.
10359
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010360 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10361 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10362 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10363 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010365
10366 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10367 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10368 forget about it.
10369
10370 Example :
10371 defaults http
10372 option http-server-close
10373 timeout connect 5s
10374 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010375 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010376 timeout server 30s
10377 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10378
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010379 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010380
10381
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010382transparent (deprecated)
10383 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010385 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010386 Arguments : none
10387
10388 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10389 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10390 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10391 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10392 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10393 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10394 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10395 appropriate server.
10396
10397 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10398
10399 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10400 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10401
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010402 See also: "option transparent"
10403
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010404unique-id-format <string>
10405 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10407 yes | yes | yes | no
10408 Arguments :
10409 <string> is a log-format string.
10410
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010411 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10412 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10413 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10414 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010415
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010416 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10417 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10418 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10419 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10420 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10421 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10422 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10423 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010424
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010425 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10426 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010427
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010428 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010429
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010430 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010431
10432 will generate:
10433
10434 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10435
10436 See also: "unique-id-header"
10437
10438unique-id-header <name>
10439 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10441 yes | yes | yes | no
10442 Arguments :
10443 <name> is the name of the header.
10444
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010445 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10446 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010447
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010448 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010449
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010450 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010451 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10452
10453 will generate:
10454
10455 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10456
10457 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010458
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010459use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010460 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10462 no | yes | yes | no
10463 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010464 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10465 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010466
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010467 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10468 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010469
10470 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10471 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10472 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010473 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010474 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010475 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10476 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010477
10478 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10479 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10480 assign the backend.
10481
10482 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10483 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10484 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10485 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10486 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10487 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10488
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010489 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010490 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010491 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10492 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10493 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10494
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010495 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10496 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10497 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10498 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10499 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10500 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10501 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10502 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10503 cannot be forced from the request.
10504
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010505 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010506 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10507 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10508
10509 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10510 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010511
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010512use-fcgi-app <name>
10513 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10515 no | no | yes | yes
10516 Arguments :
10517 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10518
10519 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010520
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010521use-server <server> if <condition>
10522use-server <server> unless <condition>
10523 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10525 no | no | yes | yes
10526 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010527 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010528
10529 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10530
10531 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10532 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10533 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10534
10535 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10536 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10537 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10538 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10539 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10540 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10541 matches will assign the server.
10542
10543 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10544 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10545 with the next rules until one matches.
10546
10547 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10548 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10549 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10550 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10551
10552 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10553 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10554 stripped.
10555
10556 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10557 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10558 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10559 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10560
10561 Example :
10562 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10563 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10564 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10565 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10566 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10567 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010568 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010569 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10570 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010572 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010573
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105755. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010576--------------------------
10577
10578The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10579depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10580settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10581written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10582described in this section.
10583
10584
105855.1. Bind options
10586-----------------
10587
10588The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10589as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10590no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10591parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10592while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10593provided immediately after the setting name.
10594
10595The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10596
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010597accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10598 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10599 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10600 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10601 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10602 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10603 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10604 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10605 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10606 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010607 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10608 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10609 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010610
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010611accept-proxy
10612 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010613 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10614 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010615 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10616 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10617 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10618 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010619 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010620 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10621 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010622 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10623 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010624
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010625allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010626 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010627 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010628 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010629 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10630 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010631
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010632alpn <protocols>
10633 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10634 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10635 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010636 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010637 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010638 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10639 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10640 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10641 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10642 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10643 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10644 preference, like below :
10645
10646 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010647
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010648backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010649 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010650 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10651
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010652curves <curves>
10653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10654 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10655 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10656 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10657 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10658 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10659
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010660ecdhe <named curve>
10661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010662 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10663 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010664
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010665ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10667 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10668 client's certificate.
10669
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010670ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10671 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10672 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10673 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10674 error is ignored.
10675
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010676ca-sign-file <cafile>
10677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10678 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10679 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10680 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10681 'generate-certificates' for details.
10682
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010683ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10685 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10686 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10687 'generate-certificates' for details.
10688
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010689ciphers <ciphers>
10690 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10691 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010692 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010693 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010694 information and recommendations see e.g.
10695 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10696 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10697 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10698
10699ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10700 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10701 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10702 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10703 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010704 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10705 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010706
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010707crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010708 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10709 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10710 to verify client's certificate.
10711
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010712crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10714 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10715 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10716 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10717 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10718 file.
10719
10720 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10721 are loaded.
10722
10723 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010724 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010725 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10726 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10727 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10728 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010729 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10730 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010731 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010732
10733 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10734 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10735 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10736 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010737 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10738 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010739
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010740 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010741
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010742 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010743 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10745 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010746 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10747 clients).
10748
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010749 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10750 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10751 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10752 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10753 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10754 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10755 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10756 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10757 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10758 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10759 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10760 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10761 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10762
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010763 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10764 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10765 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10766 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10767 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10768
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010769 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10770 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10771 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10772 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010773
10774 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10775 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10776 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10777 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10778 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10779 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10780 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10781 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10782 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10783
10784 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10785
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010786 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010787 a cert bundle.
10788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010789 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010790 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10791 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10792 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10793 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10794 provide multi-cert support.
10795
10796 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10797
10798 Filename | CN | SAN
10799 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10800 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010801 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010802 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10803 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10804
10805 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10806 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10807 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10808 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010809 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10810 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10811 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010812
10813 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10814 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10815
10816 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10817 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10818 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10819
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010820crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010822 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010823 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010824 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010825
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010826crt-list <file>
10827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010828 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10829 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010830
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010831 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10832
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010833 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10834 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010835 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010836 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010837
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010838 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10839 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10840 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10841 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10842 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10843 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10844 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10845 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010846
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010847 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010848 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010849 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10850 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10851 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010852
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010853 crt-list file example:
10854 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010855 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010856 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010857 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010858
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010859defer-accept
10860 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10861 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10862 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010863 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010864 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10865 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10866 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10867 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10868 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10869 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10870 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10871
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010872expose-fd listeners
10873 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10874 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010875 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10876 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010877 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010878
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010879force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010880 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010881 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010882 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010883 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010884
10885force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010886 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010887 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010888 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010889
10890force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010891 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010892 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010893 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010894
10895force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010896 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010897 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010898 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010899
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010900force-tlsv13
10901 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10902 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010903 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010904
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010905generate-certificates
10906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10907 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10908 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10909 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10910 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10911 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10912 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10913 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10914 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10915 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10916 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10917
10918 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10919 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010921 certificate is used many times.
10922
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010923gid <gid>
10924 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10925 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10926 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10927 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10928 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10929
10930group <group>
10931 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10932 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10933 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10934 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10935 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10936
10937id <id>
10938 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10939 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10940 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10941 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10942
10943interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010944 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10945 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10946 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10947 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10948 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10949 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010950 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10951 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10952 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10953 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10954 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10955 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010956
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010957level <level>
10958 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10959 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10960 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010961 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010962 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10963 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10964 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010965 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010966 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010967 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010968 all counters).
10969
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010970severity-output <format>
10971 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10972 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10973 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10974 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10975 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10976 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10977 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10978 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10979 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10980 rfc5424 convention.
10981
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010982maxconn <maxconn>
10983 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10984 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10985 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10986 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10987 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10988 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10989 eat all memory.
10990
10991mode <mode>
10992 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10993 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10994 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10995 UNIX sockets.
10996
10997mss <maxseg>
10998 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10999 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11000 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11001 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11002 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11003 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11004 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11005 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11006 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11007 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11008 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11009
11010name <name>
11011 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11012 page.
11013
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011014namespace <name>
11015 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11016 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11017 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11018 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11019
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011020nice <nice>
11021 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11022 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11023 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11024 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11025 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11026 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11027 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11028 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11029 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11030 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11031 one for an RDP socket.
11032
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011033no-ca-names
11034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11035 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11036
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011037no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011039 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011040 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011041 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011042 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11043 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011044
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011045no-tls-tickets
11046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11047 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11048 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011049 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11050 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011051
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011052no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011054 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011055 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011056 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011057 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11058 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011059
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011060no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011062 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011063 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011064 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011065 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11066 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011067
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011068no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011070 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011071 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011072 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011073 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11074 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011075
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011076no-tlsv13
11077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11078 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11079 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11080 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011081 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11082 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011083
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011084npn <protocols>
11085 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11086 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11087 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011088 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011089 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011090 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11091 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11092 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11093 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11094 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011095
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011096prefer-client-ciphers
11097 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11098 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11099 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011100 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11101 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11102 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011103
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011104process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011105 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011106 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011107 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011108 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11109 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11110 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11111 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011112 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011113 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11114 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11115 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11116 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11117 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011118
11119 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11120
11121 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11122 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11123 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11124 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11125 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11126 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11127 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11128 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011129
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011130proto <name>
11131 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11132 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11133 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11134 in haproxy -vv.
11135 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11136 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011137 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011138 h2" on the bind line.
11139
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011140ssl
11141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011142 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011143 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11144 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011145 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11146 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011147
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011148ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11149 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11150 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11151 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11152
11153ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11154 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11155 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11156 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11157
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011158strict-sni
11159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11160 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11161 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11162 See the "crt" option for more information.
11163
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011164tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011165 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011166 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11167 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011169 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11170 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11171 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11172 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11173 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11174 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11175 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11176
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011177tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011178 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011179 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11180 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11181 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11182 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11183 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11184 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11185 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011186 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11187 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11188 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011189
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011190tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11191 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011192 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11193 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11194 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11195 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11196 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11197 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11198 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11199 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11200 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11201 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011202 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11203 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011205transparent
11206 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11207 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11208 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11209 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11210 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11211 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11212 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11213 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11214 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11215 so check for support with your vendor.
11216
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011217v4v6
11218 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11219 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11220 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11221 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011222 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011223
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011224v6only
11225 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11226 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11227 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011228 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11229 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011230
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011231uid <uid>
11232 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11233 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11234 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11235 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11236 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11237
11238user <user>
11239 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11240 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11241 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11242 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11243 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11244
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011245verify [none|optional|required]
11246 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11247 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11248 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11249 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11250 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011251 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11252 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11253 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11254 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011255
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112565.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011257------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011259The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11260which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11261arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11262settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11263after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11264Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11265address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011267 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011268 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011269
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011270Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11271keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011273The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011274
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011275addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011276 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011277 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11278 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11279 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11280 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11281 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011282
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011283agent-check
11284 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011285 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011286 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11287 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11288 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011289
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011290 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011291 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011292 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11293 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11294 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011295
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011296 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11297 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11298 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11299 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11300 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011301
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011302 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011303 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011304
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011305 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11306 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11307 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011308
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011309 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11310 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11311 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011312
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011313 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11314 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11315 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11316 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11317 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011318 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011319 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011320
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011321 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11322 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011323
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011324 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11325 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11326 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11327 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11328 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11329 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11330 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11331 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11332 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011333
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011334 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11335 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011336 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11337 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11338 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011339 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011340
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011341 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011342 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011343
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011344agent-send <string>
11345 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11346 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11347 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11348 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11349 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11350
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011351agent-inter <delay>
11352 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11353 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11354
11355 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11356 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11357 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11358 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11359 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11360 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11361 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11362 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11363 of backends use the same servers.
11364
11365 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11366
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011367agent-addr <addr>
11368 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11369
11370 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11371 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11372 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11373 hostname, it will be resolved.
11374
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011375agent-port <port>
11376 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11377
11378 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11379
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011380allow-0rtt
11381 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011382 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11383 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011384
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011385alpn <protocols>
11386 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11387 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11388 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011389 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011390 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11391 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11392 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11393 now obsolete NPN extension.
11394 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11395 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11396
11397 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011399backup
11400 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11401 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11402 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11403 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011404 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11405 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011406
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011407ca-file <cafile>
11408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11409 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11410 server's certificate.
11411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011412check
11413 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011414 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11415 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11416 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11417 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11418 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11419 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11420 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011421 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11422 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011423 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11424 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011425
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011426check-send-proxy
11427 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11428 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11429 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11430 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11431 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11432 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11433 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11434
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011435check-alpn <protocols>
11436 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11437 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11438 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11439
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011440check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011441 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011442 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11443 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011444
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011445check-ssl
11446 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11447 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11448 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11449 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011450 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011451 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11452 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011453 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011454 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11455 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011456
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011457check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011458 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011459 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11460 for normal traffic.
11461
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011462ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11464 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11465 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011466 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11467 information and recommendations see e.g.
11468 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11469 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11470 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011471
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011472ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11474 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11475 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11476 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011477 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11478 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11479 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011481cookie <value>
11482 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11483 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11484 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11485 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11486 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11487 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11488 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11489
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011490crl-file <crlfile>
11491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11492 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11493 to verify server's certificate.
11494
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011495crt <cert>
11496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11497 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11498 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11499 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11500 certificate request.
11501
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011502disabled
11503 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11504 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11505 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11506 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11507 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011508 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011509
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011510enabled
11511 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11512 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11513 default value.
11514 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11515 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011517error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011518 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11519 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11520 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011522 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011524fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011525 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11526 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11527 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11528
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011529force-sslv3
11530 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11531 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011532 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011533 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011534
11535force-tlsv10
11536 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011537 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011538 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011539
11540force-tlsv11
11541 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011542 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011543 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011544
11545force-tlsv12
11546 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011547 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011548 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011549
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011550force-tlsv13
11551 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11552 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011553 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011555id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011556 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11557 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11558 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011559
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011560init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11561 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11562 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011563 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011564 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11565 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11566 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11567 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11568 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11569 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11570 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11571 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11572 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011573 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011574 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11575 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11576 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11577 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11578 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11579 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011580 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011581
11582 Example:
11583 defaults
11584 # never fail on address resolution
11585 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011587inter <delay>
11588fastinter <delay>
11589downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011590 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11591 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11592 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11593 between checks depending on the server state :
11594
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011595 Server state | Interval used
11596 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11597 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11598 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11599 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11600 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11601 or yet unchecked. |
11602 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11603 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11604 | "inter" otherwise.
11605 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011607 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11608 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11609 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11610 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011611 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11612 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11613 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11614 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11615 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011617maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011618 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11619 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11620 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11621 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11622 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11623 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11624 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11625 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011627maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011628 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11629 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11630 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11631 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11632 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11633 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11634 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11635
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011636max-reuse <count>
11637 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11638 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11639 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11640 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11641 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11642 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11643 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11644 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011646minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011647 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11648 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11649 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11650 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11651 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11652 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011653 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011654 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011655
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011656namespace <name>
11657 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11658 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11659 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11660 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11661
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011662no-agent-check
11663 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11664 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11665 default value.
11666 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11667 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11668
11669no-backup
11670 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11671 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11672 default value.
11673 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11674 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11675
11676no-check
11677 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11678 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11679 default value.
11680 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11681 "default-server" "check" setting.
11682
11683no-check-ssl
11684 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11685 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11686 default value.
11687 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11688 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11689
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011690no-send-proxy
11691 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11692 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11693 default value.
11694 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11695 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11696
11697no-send-proxy-v2
11698 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11699 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11700 default value.
11701 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11702 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11703
11704no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11705 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11706 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11707 default value.
11708 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11709 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11710
11711no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11712 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11713 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11714 default value.
11715 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11716 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11717
11718no-ssl
11719 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11720 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11721 default value.
11722 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11723 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11724
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011725no-ssl-reuse
11726 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11727 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11728 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11729 and for paranoid users.
11730
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011731no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011732 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11733 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011734 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011735
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011736 Supported in default-server: No
11737
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011738no-tls-tickets
11739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11740 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11741 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011742 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11743 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011744 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011745
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011746no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011747 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011748 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11749 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011750 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11751 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011752 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011753
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011754 Supported in default-server: No
11755
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011756no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011757 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011758 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11759 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011760 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11761 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011762 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011763
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011764 Supported in default-server: No
11765
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011766no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011767 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011768 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11769 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011770 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11771 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011772 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011773
11774 Supported in default-server: No
11775
11776no-tlsv13
11777 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11778 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11779 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11780 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11781 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011782 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011783
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011784 Supported in default-server: No
11785
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011786no-verifyhost
11787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11789 default value.
11790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11791 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011792
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011793no-tfo
11794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11796 default value.
11797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11798 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11799
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011800non-stick
11801 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11802 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11803 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11804
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011805npn <protocols>
11806 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11807 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11808 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011809 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011810 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11811 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11812 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011814observe <mode>
11815 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11816 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11817 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11818 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11819 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11820 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011821 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011822
11823 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011825on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011826 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11827 Currently, four modes are available:
11828 - fastinter: force fastinter
11829 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11830 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11831 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11832 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11833
11834 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11835
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011836on-marked-down <action>
11837 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11838 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011839 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11840 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11841 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11842 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11843 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11844 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11845 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11846 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011847
11848 Actions are disabled by default
11849
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011850on-marked-up <action>
11851 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11852 Currently one action is available:
11853 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11854 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11855 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11856 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011857 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11858 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011859 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11860 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11861
11862 Actions are disabled by default
11863
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011864pool-max-conn <max>
11865 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11866 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11867 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11868 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11869 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11870 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11871
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011872pool-purge-delay <delay>
11873 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011874 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011875 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011877port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011878 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11879 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11880 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11881 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11882 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11883 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11884
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011885proto <name>
11886
11887 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11888 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11889 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11890 reported in haproxy -vv.
11891 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11892 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011894redir <prefix>
11895 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11896 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11897 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11898 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11899 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11900 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11901 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11902 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011903 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011904 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011905 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11906 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11907 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11908 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11909
11910 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011912rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011913 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11914 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11915 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11916
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011917resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11918 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11919 server.
11920
11921 Available options:
11922
11923 * allow-dup-ip
11924 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11925 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11926 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11927 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11928 For such case, simply enable this option.
11929 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11930
11931 * prevent-dup-ip
11932 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11933 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11934 same fqdn.
11935 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11936
11937 Example:
11938 backend b_myapp
11939 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11940 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11941 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11942
11943 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11944 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11945 it
11946 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11947 different address
11948
11949 Default value: not set
11950
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011951resolve-prefer <family>
11952 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11953 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11954 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11955 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11956
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011957 Default value: ipv6
11958
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011959 Example:
11960
11961 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011962
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011963resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011964 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011965 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011966 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011967 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11968 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011969 configured network, another address is selected.
11970
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011971 Example:
11972
11973 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011974
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011975resolvers <id>
11976 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11977 hostname.
11978
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011979 Example:
11980
11981 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011982
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011983 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011984
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011985send-proxy
11986 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11987 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11988 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11989 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011990 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11991 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11992 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11993 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11994 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11995 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11996 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11997 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11998 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11999 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012000 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12001 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012002
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012003send-proxy-v2
12004 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12005 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12006 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12007 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012008 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12009 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12010 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12011 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012012
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012013proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12014 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12015 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012016 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12017 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012018 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12019 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012020 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012021
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012022send-proxy-v2-ssl
12023 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12024 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12025 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12026 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12027 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12028 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12029 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012030 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12031 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012032
12033send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12034 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12035 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12036 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12037 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12038 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12039 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12040 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12041 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12043 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012045slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012046 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12047 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12048 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12049 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12050 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12051 parameters :
12052
12053 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12054 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12055
12056 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12057 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12058 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12059 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12060
12061 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12062 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12063 seen as failed.
12064
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012065sni <expression>
12066 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12067 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12068 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12069 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012070 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12071 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012072 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012073 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12074 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012075
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012076source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012077source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012078source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012079 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12080 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12081 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12082 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12083
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012084 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12085 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12086 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12087 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12088 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12089 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12090 server.
12091
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012092 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12093 specifying the source address without port(s).
12094
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012095ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012096 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12097 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12098 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12099 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12100 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12101 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012102 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12103 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012104
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012105ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12106 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12107 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12108 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12109
12110ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12111 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12112 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12113 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12114
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012115ssl-reuse
12116 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12117 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12118 default value.
12119 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12120 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12121
12122stick
12123 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12124 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12125 default value.
12126 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12127 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012128
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012129socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012130 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012131 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12132 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12133
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012134tcp-ut <delay>
12135 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12136 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12137 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012138 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012139 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12140 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12141 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12142 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12143 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12144 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12145 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12146 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12147 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12148
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012149tfo
12150 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12151 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12152 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12153 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12154 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012155 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012157track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012158 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12159 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12160 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12161 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012162 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12163
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012164tls-tickets
12165 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12166 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12167 default value.
12168 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12169 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012170
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012171verify [none|required]
12172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012173 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012174 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12175 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012176 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012177 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12178 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12179 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12180 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12181 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12182 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12183 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12184 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012185
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012186verifyhost <hostname>
12187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012188 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12189 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12190 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12191 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12192 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12193 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12194 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12195 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012197weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012198 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12199 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12200 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012201 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12202 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12203 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12204 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12205 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12206 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012207
12208
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122095.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12210-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012211
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012212HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12213using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12214configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012215This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12216can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12217workload.
12218This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12219resolution at run time.
12220Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12221carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12222
12223
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122245.3.1. Global overview
12225----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012226
12227As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12228different steps of the process life:
12229
12230 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12231 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12232 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12233
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012234 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12235 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012236
12237A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12238 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12239 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12240 resolution to know this new IP.
12241
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012242When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012243HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012244SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12245from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12246will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12247will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012248
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012249A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012250 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012251 first valid response.
12252
12253 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12254 servers return an error.
12255
12256
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122575.3.2. The resolvers section
12258----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012259
12260This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012261HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12262contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012263
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012264When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12265uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12266is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12267answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12268
12269When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012270used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012271
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012272 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12273 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12274 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012275
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012276 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12277 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012278
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012279 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12280 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12281 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012282
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012283For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12284following scenarios are possible:
12285
12286 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12287 ignored
12288
12289 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12290 applied
12291
12292 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12293 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12294
12295 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12296 retries the query with a new type
12297
12298 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12299 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012300
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012301As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12302a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012303<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012304
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012305
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012306resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012307 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012308
12309A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12310
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012311accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012312 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012313 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012314 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12315 by RFC 6891)
12316
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012317 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12318
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012319nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12320 DNS server description:
12321 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12322 <ip> : IP address of the server
12323 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12324
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012325parse-resolv-conf
12326 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12327 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12328 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12329
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012330hold <status> <period>
12331 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12332 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012333 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012334 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012335 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12336 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12337 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12338
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012339 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012340
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012341resolve_retries <nb>
12342 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12343 giving up.
12344 Default value: 3
12345
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012346 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12347 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12348 type.
12349
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012350timeout <event> <time>
12351 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12352 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12353 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012354 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12355 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012356 Default value: 1s
12357 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012358 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012359 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012360 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12361 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12362
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012363 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012364
12365 resolvers mydns
12366 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12367 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012368 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012369 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012370 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012371 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012372 hold other 30s
12373 hold refused 30s
12374 hold nx 30s
12375 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012376 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012377 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012378
12379
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200123806. Cache
12381---------
12382
12383HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12384(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12385RAM.
12386
12387The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12388this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12389
12390If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12391independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12392when we try to allocate a new one.
12393
12394The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12395
12396It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12397"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12398for more details.
12399
12400When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12401replaced by "<CACHE>".
12402
12403
124046.1. Limitation
12405----------------
12406
12407The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12408
12409- If the response is not a 200
12410- If the response contains a Vary header
12411- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12412- If the response is not cacheable
12413
12414- If the request is not a GET
12415- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12416- If the request contains an Authorization header
12417
12418
124196.2. Setup
12420-----------
12421
12422To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12423the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12424
12425
124266.2.1. Cache section
12427---------------------
12428
12429cache <name>
12430 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12431 size of cache is mandatory.
12432
12433total-max-size <megabytes>
12434 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12435 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12436
12437max-object-size <bytes>
12438 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12439 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12440 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12441
12442max-age <seconds>
12443 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12444 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12445 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12446 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12447 default.
12448
12449
124506.2.2. Proxy section
12451---------------------
12452
12453http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12454 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12455 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12456 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12457 after this one.
12458
12459http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12460 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12461 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12462 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12463 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12464
12465
12466Example:
12467
12468 backend bck1
12469 mode http
12470
12471 http-request cache-use foobar
12472 http-response cache-store foobar
12473 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12474
12475 cache foobar
12476 total-max-size 4
12477 max-age 240
12478
12479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124807. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12481----------------------------------
12482
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012483HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012484client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12485The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12486these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12487but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12488data called patterns.
12489
12490
124917.1. ACL basics
12492---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012493
12494The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12495content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12496from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12497simple :
12498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012499 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012500 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12502 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012504The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12505adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012506
12507In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012509 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012510
12511This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12512Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12513and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012514an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12515conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12516as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12517are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012518
12519ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12520'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12521which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12522
12523There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12524performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012526The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12527specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12528this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012529methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12530ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012531
12532Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12533 - boolean
12534 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12535 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12536 - string
12537 - data block
12538
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012539Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12540converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12541would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12542The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12543which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12544
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012545Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12546keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12547fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12548which are summarized in the table below :
12549
12550 +---------------------+-----------------+
12551 | Sample or converter | Default |
12552 | output type | matching method |
12553 +---------------------+-----------------+
12554 | boolean | bool |
12555 +---------------------+-----------------+
12556 | integer | int |
12557 +---------------------+-----------------+
12558 | ip | ip |
12559 +---------------------+-----------------+
12560 | string | str |
12561 +---------------------+-----------------+
12562 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12563 +---------------------+-----------------+
12564
12565Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12566matching method, see below.
12567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012568The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12569 - boolean
12570 - integer or integer range
12571 - IP address / network
12572 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12573 - regular expression
12574 - hex block
12575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012576The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12577
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012578 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12579 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012581 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012582 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012583 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012584 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12587read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12588if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12589lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12590will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12591beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12592a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12593lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12594exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12595
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012596The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12597parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12598ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12599a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12600check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12601
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012602The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12603socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12604file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012606Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12607loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12608
12609 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12610
12611In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12612the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12613case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12614as well.
12615
12616The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12617sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12618do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12619methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12620is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012622followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12623default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12624that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12625string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12626
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012627The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12628By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12629string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12630resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12631server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012632waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012633flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12634function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012636There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12637sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12638be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012639
12640 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12641 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012642 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12643 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12644 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12645 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012646
12647 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12648 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012649 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012650
12651 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012652 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012653
12654 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012656
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012657 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012658 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12659
12660 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12661 binary or string samples.
12662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012663 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12664 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12667 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12668 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12671 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012673 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12674 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12677 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012679 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12680 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012681 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012683 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12684 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12685 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012686
12687For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12688request, it is possible to do :
12689
12690 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12691
12692In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12693buffer, one would use the following acl :
12694
12695 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12696
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012697On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12698possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12699
12700 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12703criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12704method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12705to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12706criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12707the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012709If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012710the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12711For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012713 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12714 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12715 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12716 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012717
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012718
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012719The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12720types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12721combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12722brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12723default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725 +-------------------------------------------------+
12726 | Input sample type |
12727 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012728 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012729 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12730 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12731 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012732 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012733 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012734 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012736 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012738 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012740 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012742 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012744 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012746 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012748 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012750 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012752 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12754 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012756
12757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127587.1.1. Matching booleans
12759------------------------
12760
12761In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12762Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12763When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12764that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12765
12766Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12767return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12768"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127717.1.2. Matching integers
12772------------------------
12773
12774Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12775enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12776to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12777
12778Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12779matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12780lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012781
12782For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12783unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12784representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12785
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012786As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12787two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12788instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12789ranges and operators.
12790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012791For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012792operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12793Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12794of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012796Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012797
12798 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12799 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12800 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12801 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12802 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012804For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012805
12806 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12807
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012808This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12809
12810 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128137.1.3. Matching strings
12814-----------------------
12815
12816String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12817different forms :
12818
12819 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012820 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821
12822 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012823 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824
12825 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12826 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12827
12828 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12829 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12830
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012831 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12833 matches.
12834
12835 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12836 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12837 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012838
12839String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12840exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12841characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12842string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12843to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012844before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012845
12846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128477.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12848---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012849
12850Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12851they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12852possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12853passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12854the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012855the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12856match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012857
12858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128597.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12860-------------------------------------
12861
12862It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12863not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12864a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12865to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12866digits may be used upper or lower case.
12867
12868Example :
12869 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12870 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12871
12872
128737.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12874---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012875
12876IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12877netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12878within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012879host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12881at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12882does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12883parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012884
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012885The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12886abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12887
12888 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12889 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12890 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12891 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12892 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12893 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12894 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12895 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12896
12897Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12898192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12899
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012900IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12901Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12902trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12903IPv6 patterns.
12904
12905HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12906following situations :
12907 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12908 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12909 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12910 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12911 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12912 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12913 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12914 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12915 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12916 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918
129197.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12920----------------------------------
12921
12922Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12923combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12924
12925 - AND (implicit)
12926 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12927 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012931 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12934indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12937"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12938requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12939is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12940
12941 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012942 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12943 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12944 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945
12946To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12947and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12948
12949 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12950 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12951 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12952 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12953
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012954 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12956 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12957 use_backend www if host_www
12958
12959It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12960expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12961be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12962the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12963
12964 The following rule :
12965
12966 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012967 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968
12969 Can also be written that way :
12970
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012971 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972
12973It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12974to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12975simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12976sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12977good use is the following :
12978
12979 With named ACLs :
12980
12981 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12982 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12983 monitor fail if site_dead
12984
12985 With anonymous ACLs :
12986
12987 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12988
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012989See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12990keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012991
12992
129937.3. Fetching samples
12994---------------------
12995
12996Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12997against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12998sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12999ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13000of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13001available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13002
13003This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13004Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13005compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13006deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13007
13008The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13009matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13010method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13011indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13012
13013As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13014when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13015mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13016the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13017ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13018
13019Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13020multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13021when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013022incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13023are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13025all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13026
13027Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13028 - name
13029 - name(arg1)
13030 - name(arg1,arg2)
13031
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013032
130337.3.1. Converters
13034-----------------
13035
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013036Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13037of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13038is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13039was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013040has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013041unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13042
13043These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13044sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13045the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013046support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013047
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013048A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13049support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13050supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13051(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13052bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013054The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013055
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001305651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13057 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13058 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13059 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13060 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13061 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13062
13063 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013064 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13065 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013066 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13067 frontend http-in
13068 bind *:8081
13069 default_backend servers
13070 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13071 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13072
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013073add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013074 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013075 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013076 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13077 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013078 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013079 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13080 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13081 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13082 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013083 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013084 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013085
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013086aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13087 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13088 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13089 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13090 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13091 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13092 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13093
13094 Example:
13095 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13096 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13097
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013098and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013099 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013100 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013101 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13102 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013103 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013104 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13105 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13106 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13107 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013109 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013110
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013111b64dec
13112 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13113 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13114
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013115base64
13116 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013117 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013118 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13119
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013120bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013121 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013122 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013123 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013124 presence of a flag).
13125
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013126bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13127 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13128 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013129 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013130
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013131concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13132 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13133 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13134 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13135 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13136 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13137 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13138 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13139 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13140 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13141 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013142 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013143 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013144 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013145
13146 Example:
13147 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13148 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13149 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13150 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13151
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013152cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013153 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13154 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013155
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013156crc32([<avalanche>])
13157 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13158 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13159 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13160 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13161 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13162 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13163 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13164 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13165 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13166 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013167 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13168
13169crc32c([<avalanche>])
13170 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13171 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13172 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13173 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13174 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13175 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13176 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13177 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013178
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013179da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013180 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13181 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13182 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13183 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013184 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013185 configuration language.
13186
13187 Example:
13188 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013189 bind *:8881
13190 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013191 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013192
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013193debug
13194 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13195 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13196 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13197
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013198div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013199 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13200 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013201 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013202 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13203 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13206 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13207 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13208 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013209 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013210 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013211
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013212djb2([<avalanche>])
13213 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13214 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13215 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13216 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13217 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13218 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13219 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013220 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13221 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013222
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013223even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013224 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013225 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13226
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013227field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13228 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13229 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13230 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13231 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13232 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13233 fields.
13234
13235 Example :
13236 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13237 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13238 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13239 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13240 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013241
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013242hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013243 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013244 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013245 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013246 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013247
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013248hex2i
13249 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013250 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013251
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013252http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013253 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13254 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013255 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13256 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13257 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13258 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13259 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13260 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13261 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13262 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013264in_table(<table>)
13265 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13266 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13267 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013268 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013269 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13270
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013271ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13272 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013273 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013274 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13275 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13276 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13277 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13278 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013279
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013280json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013281 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013282 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013283 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013284 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13285 of errors:
13286 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13287 bytes, ...)
13288 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13289 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13290
13291 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13292 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13293 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13294 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13295 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13296 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013297 - "ascii" : never fails;
13298 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13299 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013300 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013301 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013302 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13303 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13304
13305 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013306 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013307
13308 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013309 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013310 capture request header user-agent len 150
13311 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013312
13313 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13314 GET / HTTP/1.0
13315 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13316
13317 Output log:
13318 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013320language(<value>[,<default>])
13321 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13322 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13323 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13324 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13325 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13326 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13327 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13328 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13329 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013330 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013331 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13332 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013334 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013336 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13337 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013339 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13340 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13341 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13342 use_backend spanish if es
13343 use_backend french if fr
13344 use_backend english if en
13345 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013346
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013347length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013348 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13349 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13350 type. The result is of type integer.
13351
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013352lower
13353 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13354 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13355 type. The result is of type string.
13356
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013357ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13358 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13359 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13360 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13361 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13362 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13363 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13364
13365 Example :
13366
13367 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013368 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013369 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013371map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13372map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13373map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13374 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13375 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13376 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13377 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13378 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13379 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13380 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13381 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013382
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013383 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13384 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13385 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013386
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013387 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013388 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013389
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013390 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13391 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13392 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13393 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013394 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13395 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013396 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13397 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13398 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13399 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13400 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13401 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13402 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13403 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013404 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13405 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13406 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013407 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13408 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13409 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13410 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13411 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013412
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013413 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13414 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13415 the corresponding match text.
13416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013417 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13418 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13419 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13420 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13421 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013423 Example :
13424
13425 # this is a comment and is ignored
13426 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13427 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13428 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13429 | | | `---------- value
13430 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13431 | `---------------------------- key
13432 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13433
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013434mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013435 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13436 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013437 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013438 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013439 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013440 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13441 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13442 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13443 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013444 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013445 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013446
13447mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013448 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013449 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13450 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013451 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013452 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013453 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013454 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13455 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13456 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13457 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013459 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013460
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013461nbsrv
13462 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13463 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13464 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13465 map lookup.
13466
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013467neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013468 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13469 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13470 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13471 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013472
13473not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013474 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013475 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013476 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013477 absence of a flag).
13478
13479odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013480 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013481 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13482
13483or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013484 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013485 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013486 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13487 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013488 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013489 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13490 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13491 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13492 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013493 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013494 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013495
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013496protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13497 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13498 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13499 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13500 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13501 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13502 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13503 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13504 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13505 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13506 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13507 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13508
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013509regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013510 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13511 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13512 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13513 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13514 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13515 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13516 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13517 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13518 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13519 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013520 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13521 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13522 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13523 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013524
13525 Example :
13526
13527 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13528 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13529 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13530 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13531
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013532capture-req(<id>)
13533 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13534 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13535
13536 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013537 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13538 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013539
13540capture-res(<id>)
13541 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13542 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13543
13544 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013545 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13546 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013547
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013548sdbm([<avalanche>])
13549 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13550 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13551 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13552 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13553 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13554 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13555 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013556 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13557 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013558
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013559set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013560 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13561 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13562 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013563 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013564 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13565 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013566 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013567 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13568 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013569 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013570 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013571
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013572sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013573 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013574 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13575
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013576sha2([<bits>])
13577 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13578 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13579
13580 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13581 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13582
13583 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13584 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13585
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013586srv_queue
13587 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13588 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13589 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13590 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13591 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13592
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013593strcmp(<var>)
13594 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13595 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13596 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13597 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13598 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13599 shorter).
13600
13601 Example :
13602
13603 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13604 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13605 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13606
13607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013608sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013609 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13610 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013611 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013612 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13613 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013614 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013615 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13616 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013617 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013618 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13619 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013620 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013621 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013622
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013623table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13624 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13625 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13626 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13627 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13628 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13629 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13630
13631
13632table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13635 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13636 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13637 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13638 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13639
13640table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013644 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13645 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13646
13647table_conn_cur(<table>)
13648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13650 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13651 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13652 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13653
13654table_conn_rate(<table>)
13655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13657 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13658 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13659 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13660
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013661table_gpt0(<table>)
13662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13665 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13666 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13667
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013668table_gpc0(<table>)
13669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13672 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13673 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13674
13675table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13676 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13677 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13678 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13679 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13680 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13681 sample fetch keyword.
13682
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013683table_gpc1(<table>)
13684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13687 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13688 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13689
13690table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13691 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13692 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13693 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13694 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13695 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13696 sample fetch keyword.
13697
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013698table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13699 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13700 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013701 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013702 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13703 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13704
13705table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13708 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13709 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13710 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13711 keyword.
13712
13713table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013717 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13718 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13719
13720table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13723 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13724 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13725 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13726 keyword.
13727
13728table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013732 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13733 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13734 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13735 keyword.
13736
13737table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13738 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13739 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013740 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013741 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13742 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13743 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13744 keyword.
13745
13746table_server_id(<table>)
13747 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13748 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13749 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13750 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13751 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13752 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13753
13754table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013757 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013758 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13759 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13760 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13761 keyword.
13762
13763table_sess_rate(<table>)
13764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13767 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13768 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13769 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13770 keyword.
13771
13772table_trackers(<table>)
13773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13776 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13777 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13778 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13779 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13780 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13781 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13782 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13783
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013784upper
13785 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13786 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13787 type. The result is of type string.
13788
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013789url_dec
13790 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13791 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13792
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013793ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013794 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013795 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13796 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13797 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013798 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13799 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13800 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13801 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013802 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013803 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13804 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013805
13806 Example:
13807 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13808 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13809
13810 message Point {
13811 int32 latitude = 1;
13812 int32 longitude = 2;
13813 }
13814
13815 message PPoint {
13816 Point point = 59;
13817 }
13818
13819 message Rectangle {
13820 // One corner of the rectangle.
13821 PPoint lo = 48;
13822 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13823 PPoint hi = 49;
13824 }
13825
13826 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13827 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13828 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13829
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013830 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13831 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013832 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013833 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13834
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013835 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013836
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013837 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013838
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013839 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013840 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13841 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13842
13843 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13844 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13845 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13846
13847 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13848 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13849 interpret the previous binary sample.
13850
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013851
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013852unset-var(<var name>)
13853 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13854 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13855 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13856 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13857 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13858 response),
13859 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13860 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13861 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13862 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13863
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013864utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13865 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13866 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13867 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13868 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13869 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13870 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13871
13872 Example :
13873
13874 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013875 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013876 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13877
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013878word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13879 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13880 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13881 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13882 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13883 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13884
13885 Example :
13886 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13887 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13888 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13889 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13890 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013891
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013892wt6([<avalanche>])
13893 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13894 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13895 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13896 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13897 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13898 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13899 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013900 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13901 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013902
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013903xor(<value>)
13904 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013905 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013906 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013907 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013908 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013909 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13910 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013911 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013912 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13913 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013914 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013915 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013916
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013917xxh32([<seed>])
13918 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13919 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13920 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13921 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13922 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13923 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13924 as cryptographically secure.
13925
13926xxh64([<seed>])
13927 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13928 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13929 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13930 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13931 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13932 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13933 as cryptographically secure.
13934
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013935
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139367.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013937--------------------------------------------
13938
13939A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13940not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13941"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13942The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13943
13944always_false : boolean
13945 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13946 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13947
13948always_true : boolean
13949 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13950 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13951
13952avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013953 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13955 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13956 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13957 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13958 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13959 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13960 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13961 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13962 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13963 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13964 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13965 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13966 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013969 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13970 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13971 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13972 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013973 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13974
13975be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13976 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13977 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13978 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13979 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13980 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013981 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13982 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013983
13984 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13985 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13986 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13989 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13990 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13991 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013992 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13994 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013995
13996 Example :
13997 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13998 backend dynamic
13999 mode http
14000 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14001 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014003bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014004 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14005 of the string.
14006
14007bool(<bool>) : bool
14008 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14009 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014013 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14015 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014016
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014017 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014018 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014019 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14020
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014021 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14022 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014023
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014024 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014025 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014027 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014028 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014029 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014030 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014031
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014032 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14033 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014035 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014036
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014037cpu_calls : integer
14038 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14039 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14040 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14041 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14042 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14043 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14044
14045cpu_ns_avg : integer
14046 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14047 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14048 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14049 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14050 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14051 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14052 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14053 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14054 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14055 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14056 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14057
14058cpu_ns_tot : integer
14059 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14060 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14061 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14062 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14063 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14064 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14065 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14066 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14067 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14068 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14069 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14070 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14071 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14072
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014073date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014074 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014075
14076 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14077 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14078 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014079 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14080
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014081 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14082 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14083 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14084 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14085 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14086
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014087 Example :
14088
14089 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14090 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014091
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014092 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14093 # millisecond granularity
14094 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14095
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014096date_us : integer
14097 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14098 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14099 from the same timeval structure.
14100
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014101distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14102 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14103 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14104 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14105 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14106 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14107 list of supported tokens.
14108
14109distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14110 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14111 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14112 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14113 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14114 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14115 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14116 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14117 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14118 supported tokens.
14119
14120 Example :
14121 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14122 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14123 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14124 # send large files to the big farm
14125 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14126
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014127env(<name>) : string
14128 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14129 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14130 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14131 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14132 certain way.
14133
14134 Examples :
14135 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14136 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14137
14138 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14139 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014141fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14142 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014143 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14144 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14146 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014147 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14149 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014150
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014151fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14153 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14154 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14157 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14158 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14159 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14160 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14161 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14162 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14163 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14164 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014165
14166 Example :
14167 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14168 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14169 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14170 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14171 frontend mail
14172 bind :25
14173 mode tcp
14174 maxconn 100
14175 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14176 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14177 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14178 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014179
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014180hostname : string
14181 Returns the system hostname.
14182
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014183int(<integer>) : signed integer
14184 Returns a signed integer.
14185
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014186ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14187 Returns an ipv4.
14188
14189ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14190 Returns an ipv6.
14191
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014192lat_ns_avg : integer
14193 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14194 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14195 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14196 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14197 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14198 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14199 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14200 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14201 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14202 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14203 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14204 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14205 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14206 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14207
14208lat_ns_tot : integer
14209 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14210 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14211 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14212 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14213 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14214 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14215 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14216 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14217 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14218 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14219 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14220 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14221 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14222 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14223 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14224 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14225 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14226 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14227 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14228
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014229meth(<method>) : method
14230 Returns a method.
14231
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014232nbproc : integer
14233 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14234 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14235 and debugging purposes.
14236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14238 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14239 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14240 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014241 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14242 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14243 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014244
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014245prio_class : integer
14246 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14247 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14248 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14249
14250prio_offset : integer
14251 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14252 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14253 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14254 set-priority-offset".
14255
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014256proc : integer
14257 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14258 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14259 debugging purposes.
14260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014262 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14263 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14264 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014265 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14266 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14267 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14268 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14269 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14270
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014271rand([<range>]) : integer
14272 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14273 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14274 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14275 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14276 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14277
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014278uuid([<version>]) : string
14279 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14280 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14281 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14284 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14285 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14286 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14287 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14288 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014289 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14290 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14291
14292srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14294 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14295 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14296 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14297 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14298 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14299 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14300
14301 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14302 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014303
14304srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14305 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14306 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14307 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014308 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014309 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14310 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14311 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14312
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014313srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14314 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14315 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14316 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14317 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14318 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14319 fetch methods.
14320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14322 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14323 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014324 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14326 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014327 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328 overloading servers).
14329
14330 Example :
14331 # Redirect to a separate back
14332 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14333 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14334 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14335
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014336stopping : boolean
14337 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14338 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14339 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14340
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014341str(<string>) : string
14342 Returns a string.
14343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014344table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14345 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14346 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14347
14348table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14349 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14350 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14351 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14352
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014353thread : integer
14354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14355 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14356 and debugging purposes.
14357
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014358var(<var-name>) : undefined
14359 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014360 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14361 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014362 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014363 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14364 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014365 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014366 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14367 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014368 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014369 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372----------------------------------
14373
14374The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14375closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14376methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14377sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14378TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014379the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14380counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014381"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14382used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14383can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14384Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14385table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14386tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14387currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014389bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014390 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14391 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14392 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394be_id : integer
14395 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14396 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14397
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014398be_name : string
14399 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14400 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014402dst : ip
14403 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14404 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14405 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14406 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014407 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14408 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14409 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14410 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14411 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14412 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014413
14414dst_conn : integer
14415 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14416 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14417 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14418 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14419 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14420 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14421 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14422 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014423
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014424dst_is_local : boolean
14425 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14426 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14427 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14428 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014430 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14431 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14432 it only once per connection.
14433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434dst_port : integer
14435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14436 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14437 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14438 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14439 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14440 an HTTP header.
14441
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014442fc_http_major : integer
14443 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14444 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14445 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14446
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014447fc_pp_authority : string
14448 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14449 if any.
14450
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014451fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14452 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14453 header.
14454
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014455fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14456 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14457 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14458 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14459 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14460 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14461 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14462
14463fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14464 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14465 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14466 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14467 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14468 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14469 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14470
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014471fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014472 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14473 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14474 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14475 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14476
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014477fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014478 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14479 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14480 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14481 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14482
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014483fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014484 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14485 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14486 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14487 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14488
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014489fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014490 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14491 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14492 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14493 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14494
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014495fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014496 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14497 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14498 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14499 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14500
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014501fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014502 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14503 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14504 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14505 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14506
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014507fe_defbe : string
14508 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14509 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511fe_id : integer
14512 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014513 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014514 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14515
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014516fe_name : string
14517 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14518 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14519 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14520
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014521sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014522sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14523sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14524sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014525 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14526 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14527 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14528
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014529sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014530sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14531sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14532sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014533 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14534 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14535 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014537sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014538sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14539sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14540sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014541 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14542 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014543 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14544 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14545 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014546
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014547 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014548 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14549 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014550 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14551 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14552 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014553 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14554 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14555
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014556sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14557sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14558sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14559sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14560 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14561 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14562 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14563 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14564 when a first ACL was verified.
14565
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014566sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014567sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14568sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14569sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014570 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014571 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014573sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014574sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14575sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14576sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014577 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14578 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14579 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14580
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014581sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014582sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14583sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14584sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014585 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14586 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14587 See also src_conn_rate.
14588
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014589sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014590sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14591sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14592sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014593 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014594 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014595
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014596sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14597sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14598sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14599sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14600 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14601 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14602
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014603sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14604sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14605sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14606sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14607 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14608 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14609
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014610sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014611sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14612sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14613sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014614 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14615 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14616 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014617 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14618 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14619 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014620
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014621sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14622sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14623sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14624sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14625 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14626 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14627 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14628 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14629 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14630 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14631
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014632sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014633sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14634sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14635sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014636 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014637 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14638 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014640sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014641sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14642sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14643sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014644 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14645 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14646 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14647 src_http_err_rate.
14648
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014649sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014650sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14651sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14652sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014653 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014654 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14655 src_http_req_cnt.
14656
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014657sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014658sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14659sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14660sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014661 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14662 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14663 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14664 src_http_req_rate.
14665
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014666sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014667sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14668sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14669sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014670 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014671 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14672 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14673 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14674 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014675
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014676 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014677 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14678 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014679 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14680
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014681sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14682sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14683sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14684sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14685 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14686 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14687 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14688 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14689 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014691sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014692sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14693sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14694sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014695 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14696 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14697 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014699sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014700sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14701sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14702sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014703 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14704 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14705 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014707sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014708sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14709sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14710sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014711 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014712 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14713 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14714 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014715 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014716 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014718sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014719sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14720sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14721sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014722 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14723 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14724 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14725 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14726 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014727 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014728
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014729sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014730sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14731sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14732sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014733 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14734 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14735 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014737sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014738sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14739sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14740sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014741 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14742 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014743 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014744 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14745 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14747 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14748 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014750so_id : integer
14751 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14752 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14753 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14758 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14759 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014760 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14761 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14762 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014763 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14764 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14765 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14766 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14767 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14768 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14769 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014770
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014771 Example:
14772 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14773 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14776 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14777 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14778 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014779 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14782 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14783 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014784 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014785 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14788 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14789 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14790 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14791 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14792 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14793 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014794
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014795 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014796 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14797 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14798 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14799 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014800 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014801 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14802 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14803
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014804src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14805 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14806 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14807 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14808 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14809 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14810 was verified.
14811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014812src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014813 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014815 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014816 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014819 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14821 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014822 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14825 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14826 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14827 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014828 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014831 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014833 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014834 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014835
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014836src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14837 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14838 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14839 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14840 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14841
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014842src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14843 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14844 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14845 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14846 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014849 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014851 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14852 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014853 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14854 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14855 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014856
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014857src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14858 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14859 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14860 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14861 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14862 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14863 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14864 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014867 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014869 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014870 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14874 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14875 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14876 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14877 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014878 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014881 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14883 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014884 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14887 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14888 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14889 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014890 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014891 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14894 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14895 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14896 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014897 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14899 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014900
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014901 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014902 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014903 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014904 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014905
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014906src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14907 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14908 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14909 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14910 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14911 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14912 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14913
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014914src_is_local : boolean
14915 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14916 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14917 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14918 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014919 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014920 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14921 once per connection.
14922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014924 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14925 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14926 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14927 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14928 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014931 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14932 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14933 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14934 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14935 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937src_port : integer
14938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14939 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14940 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14941 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014944 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014945 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14946 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14947 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014948 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14951 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14952 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14953 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14954 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014955 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14958 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14959 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14960 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14961 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14962 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14963 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14964 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14965 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014966
14967 Example :
14968 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14969 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14970 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14971 listen ssh
14972 bind :22
14973 mode tcp
14974 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014975 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014977 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979srv_id : integer
14980 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14981 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14982 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014983
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080014984srv_name : string
14985 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
14986 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14987 debugging.
14988
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014990----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14993closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14994when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14995usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014996future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014997
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001499851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14999 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15000 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15001 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15002 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15003 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15004
15005 Example :
15006 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15007 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15008 # the request.
15009 frontend http-in
15010 bind *:8081
15011 default_backend servers
15012 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15013 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15014
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015015ssl_bc : boolean
15016 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15017 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15018 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15019
15020ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15021 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15022 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15023
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015024ssl_bc_alpn : string
15025 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15026 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015027 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015028 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15029 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15030 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15031 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15032 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15033 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15034
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015035ssl_bc_cipher : string
15036 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15037 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15038
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015039ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15040 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15041 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15042 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15043
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015044ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15045 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15046 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15047 session or a TLS ticket.
15048
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015049ssl_bc_npn : string
15050 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15051 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015052 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015053 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15054 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15055 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15056 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15057 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15058
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015059ssl_bc_protocol : string
15060 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15061 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15062
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015063ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015064 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015065 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15066 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015067
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015068ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15069 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15070 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15071 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15072
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015073ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15074 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15075 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15076 if session was reused or not.
15077
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015078ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15079 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15080 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15081 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15082 BoringSSL.
15083
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015084ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15085 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15086 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15089 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15090 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15091 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15092 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15093 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15096 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15097 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15098 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15099 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015100
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015101ssl_c_der : binary
15102 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15103 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15104 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015106ssl_c_err : integer
15107 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15108 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15109 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15110 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15111 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15114 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15115 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15116 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15117 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15118 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15119 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15120 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15121 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123ssl_c_key_alg : string
15124 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15125 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15126 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128ssl_c_notafter : string
15129 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15130 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15131 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133ssl_c_notbefore : string
15134 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15135 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15136 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15139 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15140 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15141 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15142 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15143 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15144 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15145 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15146 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148ssl_c_serial : binary
15149 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15150 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15151 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15154 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15155 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15156 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015157 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15158 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15159
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015160 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015161 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15164 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15165 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15166 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168ssl_c_used : boolean
15169 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15170 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172ssl_c_verify : integer
15173 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15174 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15175 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15176 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178ssl_c_version : integer
15179 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15180 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015181
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015182ssl_f_der : binary
15183 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15184 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15185 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15188 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15189 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15190 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15191 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015192 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15194 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15195 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197ssl_f_key_alg : string
15198 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15199 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15200 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_f_notafter : string
15203 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15204 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15205 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207ssl_f_notbefore : string
15208 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15209 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15210 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15213 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15214 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15215 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15216 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15217 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15218 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15219 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15220 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015222ssl_f_serial : binary
15223 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15224 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15225 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015226
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015227ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15228 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15229 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15230 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15233 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15234 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15235 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237ssl_f_version : integer
15238 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15239 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15240
15241ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015242 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15243 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15244 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246 Example :
15247 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15248 listen http-https
15249 bind :80
15250 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15251 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15252
15253ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15254 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15255 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15256
15257ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015258 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15260 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15261 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15262 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15263 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15264 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15265 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15266 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268ssl_fc_cipher : string
15269 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15270 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015271
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015272ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15273 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15274 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015275 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015276
15277ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15278 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15279 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015280 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015281
15282ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15283 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15284 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15285 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015286 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015287 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015288
15289ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15290 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15291 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015292 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015293
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015294ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15295 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15296 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15297 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015300 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15301 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015302 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15303 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15304 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15305 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015306
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015307ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15308 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15309 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15310 wait until the handshake happened.
15311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15313 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015314 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15315 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015316 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015317 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015318
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015319ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015320 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015321 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15322 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015325 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15327 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15328 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15329 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15330 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15331 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15332 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334ssl_fc_protocol : string
15335 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15336 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015337
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015338ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015339 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015340 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15341 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015342
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015343ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15344 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15345 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15346 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15349 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15350 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15351 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15352 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015353
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015354ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15355 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15356 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15357 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15358 BoringSSL.
15359
15360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015361ssl_fc_sni : string
15362 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15363 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15364 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15365 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15366 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15367
15368 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15369 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15370 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015371 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015372 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15376 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015378ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15379 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15380 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015381
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015382
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15387sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15388only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15389For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15390be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15391can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15392sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15393for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15394content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015397 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15399 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15402 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015403 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015405
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015406req.hdrs : string
15407 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15408 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15409 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15410 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15411
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015412req.hdrs_bin : binary
15413 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15414 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15415 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15416 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15417 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15418 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15419
15420 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15421
15422 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15423 str: <int:length><bytes>
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425req.len : integer
15426req_len : integer (deprecated)
15427 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15428 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15429 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15430 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15431 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15432 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15433 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15434 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15437 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015438 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15439 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15440 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15441 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443 ACL alternatives :
15444 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15447 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15448 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15449 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15450 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452 ACL alternatives :
15453 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457req.proto_http : boolean
15458req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15459 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15460 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15461 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15462 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15463 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15464 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15465 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 Example:
15468 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15469 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15470 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015471 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15474rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15475 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15476 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15477 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15478 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15479 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15480 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15481 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15484 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15485 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15486 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15487 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15488 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 ACL derivatives :
15491 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493 Example :
15494 listen tse-farm
15495 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15496 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15497 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15498 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15499 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15500 persist rdp-cookie
15501 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15502 # This is only useful makes sense if
15503 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15504 stick-table type string size 204800
15505 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15506 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15507 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15510 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15513rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15514 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15515 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15516 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15517 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 ACL derivatives :
15520 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015521
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015522req.ssl_alpn : string
15523 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15524 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15525 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15526 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15527 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15528 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015529 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015530
15531 Examples :
15532 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15533 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15534 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015535 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015536 default_backend bk_default
15537
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015538req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15539 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15540 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015541 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15542 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15543 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15544 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15545 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15548req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15549 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15550 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15551 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15552 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15553 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15554 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15555 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557req.ssl_sni : string
15558req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15559 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15560 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15561 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15562 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15563 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15564 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15565 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15566 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15567 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15568 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15569 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15570 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 ACL derivatives :
15573 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575 Examples :
15576 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15577 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15578 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15579 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15580 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015581
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015582req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15583 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15584 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15585 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15586 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15587 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15588 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15589 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15590 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15591 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593req.ssl_ver : integer
15594req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15595 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15596 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15597 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15598 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15599 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15600 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15601 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015602 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 ACL derivatives :
15606 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015607
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015608res.len : integer
15609 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15610 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15611 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15612 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15613 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15614 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15615 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15616 content inspection.
15617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15619 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015620 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15621 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15622 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15623 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15626 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15627 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15628 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15629 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015632
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015633res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15634rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15635 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15636 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15637 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15638 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15639 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15640 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15641 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643wait_end : boolean
15644 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15645 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015646 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15648 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015649 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15651 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 Examples :
15654 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15655 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15656 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15659 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15660 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15661 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15662 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15663 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15664 tcp-request content reject
15665
15666
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156677.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668--------------------------------------
15669
15670It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15671This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15672data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15673its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15674HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15675content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15676to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15677more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15678response are indexed.
15679
15680base : string
15681 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15682 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15683 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15684 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15685 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15686 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15687 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15688 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15689
15690 ACL derivatives :
15691 base : exact string match
15692 base_beg : prefix match
15693 base_dir : subdir match
15694 base_dom : domain match
15695 base_end : suffix match
15696 base_len : length match
15697 base_reg : regex match
15698 base_sub : substring match
15699
15700base32 : integer
15701 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15702 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15703 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015704 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15705 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15706 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707
15708base32+src : binary
15709 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15710 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15711 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15712 per-URL counters.
15713
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015714capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15715 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15716 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15717 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15718
15719capture.req.method : string
15720 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15721 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15722 because it's allocated.
15723
15724capture.req.uri : string
15725 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15726 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15727 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15728 allocated.
15729
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015730capture.req.ver : string
15731 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15732 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15733 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15734
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015735capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15736 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15737 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15738 The first entry is an index of 0.
15739 See also: "capture response header"
15740
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015741capture.res.ver : string
15742 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15743 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15744 persistent flag.
15745
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015746req.body : binary
15747 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15748 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15749 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15750 the first chunk is analyzed.
15751
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015752req.body_param([<name>) : string
15753 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15754 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15755 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15756 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15757 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15758 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15759 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15760 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15761 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15762 given.
15763
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015764req.body_len : integer
15765 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15766 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15767 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15768 "option http-buffer-request".
15769
15770req.body_size : integer
15771 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15772 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15773 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15774 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15775 "option http-buffer-request".
15776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777req.cook([<name>]) : string
15778cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15779 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15780 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15781 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15782 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15783 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15784 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15785 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15786 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15787
15788 ACL derivatives :
15789 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15790 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15791 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15792 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15793 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15794 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15795 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15796 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15799cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15800 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15801 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15804cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15805 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15806 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15807 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15808 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15811 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15812 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15813 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15814 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015815 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15817 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15818 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15819 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15822 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15823 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15824 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15825 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015826 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15829 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15830 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15831 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15832 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15833 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15834 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15835 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15836 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015838req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15839 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15840 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15841 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15842 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15845 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15846 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15847 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15848 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15849 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15850 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15851 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15852 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015853 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015855 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857 ACL derivatives :
15858 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15859 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15860 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15861 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15862 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15863 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15864 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15865 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15866
15867req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15868hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15869 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15870 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15871 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15872 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15873 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15874 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15875 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15876 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15877 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15878
15879req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15880hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15881 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15882 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15883 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15884 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15885 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015886 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15888 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15889
15890req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15891hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15892 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15893 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15894 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15895 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15896 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15897 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15898 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15899
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015900
15901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15903 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15904 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15905 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15906 basic auth is supported.
15907
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015908http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15909 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15910 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15911 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15912 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15914 basic auth is supported.
15915
15916 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015917 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15918 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15919 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15920 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015922http_auth_pass : string
15923 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15924 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15925 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15926
15927http_auth_type : string
15928 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15929 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15930 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15931
15932http_auth_user : string
15933 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
15934 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
15935 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015938 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15939 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15941 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943method : integer + string
15944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15945 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15946 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15947 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15948 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15949 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15950 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 ACL derivatives :
15953 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955 Example :
15956 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15957 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15958 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960path : string
15961 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15962 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15963 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15964 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15965 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015966 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 ACL derivatives :
15970 path : exact string match
15971 path_beg : prefix match
15972 path_dir : subdir match
15973 path_dom : domain match
15974 path_end : suffix match
15975 path_len : length match
15976 path_reg : regex match
15977 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015978
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015979query : string
15980 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15981 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15982 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15983 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015984 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015985 which stops before the question mark.
15986
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015987req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15988 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15989 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15990 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15991 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015993req.ver : string
15994req_ver : string (deprecated)
15995 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15996 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15997 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 ACL derivatives :
16000 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002res.comp : boolean
16003 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16004 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16005 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007res.comp_algo : string
16008 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16009 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16010 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012res.cook([<name>]) : string
16013scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16014 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16015 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16016 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018 ACL derivatives :
16019 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16022scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16023 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16024 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16025 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16028scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16029 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16030 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16031 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16034 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16035 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16036 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16037 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16038 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16039 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16040 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16041 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16042 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16045 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16046 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16047 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16048 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16049 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16052shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16053 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16054 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16055 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16056 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16057 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16058 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16059 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16060 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062 ACL derivatives :
16063 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16064 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16065 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16066 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16067 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16068 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16069 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16070 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16071
16072res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16073shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16074 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16075 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16076 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16077 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16078 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16081shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16082 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16083 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16084 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16085 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16086 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16087 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016088
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016089res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16090 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16091 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16092 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16093 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16096shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16097 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16098 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16099 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16100 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16101 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16102 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104res.ver : string
16105resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16106 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16107 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 ACL derivatives :
16110 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16113 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16114 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016115 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16119 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121status : integer
16122 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16123 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16124 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016125
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016126unique-id : string
16127 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16128 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16129 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16130 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16131 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16132 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134url : string
16135 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16136 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16137 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16138 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16139 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16140 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16141 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143 ACL derivatives :
16144 url : exact string match
16145 url_beg : prefix match
16146 url_dir : subdir match
16147 url_dom : domain match
16148 url_end : suffix match
16149 url_len : length match
16150 url_reg : regex match
16151 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153url_ip : ip
16154 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16155 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16156 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16157 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16158 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16159 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16160 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162url_port : integer
16163 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16164 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16165 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16166 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016167
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016168urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16169url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16171 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016172 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16173 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16174 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16175 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16177 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016178 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16179 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181 ACL derivatives :
16182 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16183 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16184 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16185 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16186 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16187 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16188 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16189 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016190
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192 Example :
16193 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16194 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16195 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16196 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016197
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016198urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16200 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16201 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016202
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016203url32 : integer
16204 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16205 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16206 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16207 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16208 is an unsigned integer.
16209
16210url32+src : binary
16211 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16212 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16213 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16214
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016217---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016219Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16220every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016221order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016223ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16224---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016225FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016226HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016227HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16228HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016229HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16230HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16231HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16232HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16233LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016234METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016235METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016236METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16237METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16238METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16239METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016240METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016241METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016242RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016243REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016244TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016245WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16246---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016247
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162498. Logging
16250----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016251
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016252One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16253provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16254very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16255provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16256state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016257to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016258headers.
16259
16260In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16261about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16262send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16263
16264 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16265 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16266 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16267 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16268 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016269 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016270 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016271
16272The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16273allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16274as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16275while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16276real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16277delay.
16278
16279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162808.1. Log levels
16281---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016282
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016283TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016284source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016285HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16286in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16287track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16288syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16289about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016290
16291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162928.2. Log formats
16293----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016295HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016296and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16297slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16298options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016299
16300 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16301 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16302 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16303 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16304 extents.
16305
16306 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16307 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16308 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16309 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16310 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16311
16312 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16313 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16314 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16315 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16316 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16317
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016318 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16319 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16320 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16321 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16322
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016323 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16324
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016325Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16326specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16327field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16328servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16329always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16330identifier.
16331
16332Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16333 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16334 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16335 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16336 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16337
16338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163398.2.1. Default log format
16340-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016341
16342This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16343as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16344format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16345
16346 Example :
16347 listen www
16348 mode http
16349 log global
16350 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16351
16352 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16353 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16354 (www/HTTP)
16355
16356 Field Format Extract from the example above
16357 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16358 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16359 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16360 4 'to' to
16361 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16362 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16363
16364Detailed fields description :
16365 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16366 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16367 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16368 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16369 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16370 and processed the connection.
16371 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16372
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016373In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16374"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16375connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16376
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016377It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16378will eventually disappear.
16379
16380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163818.2.2. TCP log format
16382---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016383
16384The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16385is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16386information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16387counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16388emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16389environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16390the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16391sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016392specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16393not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16394fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16395marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016396
16397 Example :
16398 frontend fnt
16399 mode tcp
16400 option tcplog
16401 log global
16402 default_backend bck
16403
16404 backend bck
16405 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16406
16407 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16408 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16409 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16410
16411 Field Format Extract from the example above
16412 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16413 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16414 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16415 4 frontend_name fnt
16416 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16417 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16418 7 bytes_read* 212
16419 8 termination_state --
16420 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16421 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16422
16423Detailed fields description :
16424 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016425 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16426 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16427 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016428 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016429 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016430 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016431
16432 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016433 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16434 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16435 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016436
16437 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16438 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16439 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016440 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16441 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16442 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16443 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016444
16445 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16446 and processed the connection.
16447
16448 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16449 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16450 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16451 applications.
16452
16453 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16454 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16455 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16456 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16457 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16458
16459 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16460 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16461 See "Timers" below for more details.
16462
16463 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16464 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16465 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16466 "Timers" below for more details.
16467
16468 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016469 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016470 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16471 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16472 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16473 details.
16474
16475 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16476 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16477 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16478 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16479 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16480
16481 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16482 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16483 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16484 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16485 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16486 for more details.
16487
16488 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016489 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016490 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16491 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16492 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016493 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016494
16495 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16496 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16497 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16498 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16499 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16500 caused by a denial of service attack.
16501
16502 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16503 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16504 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16505 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16506 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16507 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16508 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16509 denial of service attack.
16510
16511 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16512 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16513 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16514 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16515 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16516 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16517 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16518 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16519 be processed than on other servers.
16520
16521 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16522 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16523 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16524 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16525 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16526 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16527 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16528 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16529 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16530 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16531 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16532 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16533 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16534
16535 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16536 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16537 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16538 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16539 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16540 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016541 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016542 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16543
16544 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16545 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16546 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16547 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16548 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16549 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016550 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016551 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16552 occurs.
16553
16554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165558.2.3. HTTP log format
16556----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016557
16558The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16559is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16560the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16561are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16562emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16563generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16564"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16565which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016566frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16567is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016568
16569Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16570slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16571with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16572
16573 Example :
16574 frontend http-in
16575 mode http
16576 option httplog
16577 log global
16578 default_backend bck
16579
16580 backend static
16581 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16582
16583 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16584 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16585 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016586 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587
16588 Field Format Extract from the example above
16589 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16590 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016591 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016592 4 frontend_name http-in
16593 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016594 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016595 7 status_code 200
16596 8 bytes_read* 2750
16597 9 captured_request_cookie -
16598 10 captured_response_cookie -
16599 11 termination_state ----
16600 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16601 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16602 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16603 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16604 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016606Detailed fields description :
16607 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016608 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16609 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16610 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016611 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016612 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016613 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016614
16615 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016616 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16617 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16618 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016619
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016620 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16621 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016622
16623 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16624 and processed the connection.
16625
16626 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16627 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16628 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16629
16630 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16631 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16632 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16633 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16634 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16635 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016637 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16638 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16639 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016640 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016641 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16642 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016643 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16644 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016645
16646 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16647 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016648 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016649
16650 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16651 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016652 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16653 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16656 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16657 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16658 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16659 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016660 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16661 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016663 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16664 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16665 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16666 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16667 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16668 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16669 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016670 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016671
16672 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16673 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16674 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16675
16676 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16677 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016678 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016679 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16680 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16681 overflowing.
16682
16683 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16684 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16685 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16686 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16687 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16688 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16689 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16690 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16691
16692 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16693 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16694 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16695 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16696 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16697 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16698 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16699 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16700
16701 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16702 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16703 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16704 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16705 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16706 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16707 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16708
16709 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016710 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016711 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16712 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16713 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016714 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016715 system.
16716
16717 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16718 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16719 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16720 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16721 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16722 caused by a denial of service attack.
16723
16724 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16725 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16726 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16727 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16728 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16729 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16730 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16731 denial of service attack.
16732
16733 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16734 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16735 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16736 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16737 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16738 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16739 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16740 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16741 processed than on other servers.
16742
16743 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16744 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16745 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16746 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16747 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16748 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16749 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16750 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16751 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16752 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16753 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16754 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16755 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16756
16757 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16758 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16759 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16760 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16761 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16762 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016763 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016764 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16765
16766 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16767 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16768 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16769 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16770 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16771 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016772 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016773 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16774 occurs.
16775
16776 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16777 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16778 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16779 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16780 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16781 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16782 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16783 cookies" below for more details.
16784
16785 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16786 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16787 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16788 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16789 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16790 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16791 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16792 and cookies" below for more details.
16793
16794 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16795 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16796 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16797 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16798 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16799 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16800 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16801 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16802
16803
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168048.2.4. Custom log format
16805------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016806
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016807The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016808mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016809
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016810HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016811Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16812separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16813prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16814
16815Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16816variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016817("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016818
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016819If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016820as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016821less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16822the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16823
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016824Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016825In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016826in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016827
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016828Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16829'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16830https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16831such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16832
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016833Flags are :
16834 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016835 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016836 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16837 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016838
16839 Example:
16840
16841 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16842 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16843
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016844 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16845
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016846At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16847
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016848 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16849 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016850
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016851the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016853 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16854 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16855 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016856
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016857and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16858
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016859 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16860 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016861
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016862Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16863
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016864 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016865 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016866 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16867 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16868 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016869 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16870 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16871 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016872 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016873 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16874 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016875 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016876 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16877 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016878 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016879 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016880 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016881 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016882 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016883 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016884 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016885 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16886 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16887 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16888 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16889 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016890 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016891 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16892 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016893 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016894 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16895 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016896 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16897 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16898 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016899 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016900 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16901 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016902 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016903 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16904 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16905 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016906 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016907 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016908 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16909 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16910 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16911 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016912 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016913 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016914 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016915 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016916 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016917 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016918 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16919 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16920 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016921 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016922 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16923 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016924 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016925 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16926 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016927 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016928 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016929 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016930 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016931
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016932 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016933
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016934
169358.2.5. Error log format
16936-----------------------
16937
16938When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16939protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16940By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16941"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016942will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016943logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16944
16945The format looks like this :
16946
16947 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16948 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16949 Connection error during SSL handshake
16950
16951 Field Format Extract from the example above
16952 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16953 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16954 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16955 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16956 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16957
16958These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16959failures.
16960
16961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169628.3. Advanced logging options
16963-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016964
16965Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16966just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16967options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16968for more information about their usage.
16969
16970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169718.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16972------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016973
16974It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16975haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16976commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16977monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16978ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16979
16980 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16981 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16982 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16983 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16984
16985 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16986 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16987 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016988 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016989 such as other load-balancers.
16990
16991 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16992 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16993 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16994
16995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16997----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016998
16999The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17000what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17001or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017002"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17004log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17005after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17006is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17007with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17008with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17009
17010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170118.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17012------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017013
17014Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17015for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17016"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17017retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17018raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17019a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17020file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17021you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17022"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17023
17024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170258.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17026--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017027
17028Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17029multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17030them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17031"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17032logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17033error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17034and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17035too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17036useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17037alternative.
17038
17039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170408.4. Timing events
17041------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017042
17043Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17044reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17045the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17046frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017047mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17048addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17049
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017050Timings events in HTTP mode:
17051
17052 first request 2nd request
17053 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17054 t tr t tr ...
17055 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17056 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17057 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17058 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17059 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17060
17061Timings events in TCP mode:
17062
17063 TCP session
17064 |<----------------->|
17065 t t
17066 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17067 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17068 |<------ Tt ------->|
17069
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017070 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017071 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017072 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17073 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17074 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017075 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017076 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17077 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17078 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17079 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017080
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017081 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17082 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17083 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017084 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17085 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17086 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17087 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17088 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17089 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017090
17091 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17092 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17093 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17094 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17095 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17096 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17097 request typed by hand during a test.
17098
17099 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17100 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017101 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017102 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17103 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17104 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17105 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017106
17107 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17108 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17109 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17110 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17111 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17112
17113 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17114 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17115 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17116 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17117 connection never established.
17118
17119 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17120 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17121 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17122 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17123 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17124 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17125 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17126 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17127 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17128 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17129 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017131 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17132 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17133 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17134 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17135 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17136 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17137
17138 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17139
17140 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17141 "Ta" can never be negative.
17142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017143 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17144 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017145 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17146 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017147 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017149 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017150
17151 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017152 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17153 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017154
17155These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17156protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17157that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017158due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17159"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17160that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161
17162Most common cases :
17163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017164 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17165 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17166 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17167 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17168 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17169 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17170 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17171 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17172 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17173 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17174 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017175 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017176
17177 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17178 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17179 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17180 of ms on remote networks.
17181
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017182 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17183 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17184 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017186 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17187 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17188 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17189 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17190 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17191 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17192 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17193 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17194 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195
17196Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17197
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017198 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017200 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017202 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017203 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17204 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17205
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017206 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017207 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17208 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17209 flags.
17210
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017211 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17212 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17214 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17215 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17216 the client connection was maintained open.
17217
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017218 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017219 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017221 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17222
17223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172248.5. Session state at disconnection
17225-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017226
17227TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17228"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172292-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17230each of which has a special meaning :
17231
17232 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17233 session to terminate :
17234
17235 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17236
17237 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17238 server explicitly refused it.
17239
17240 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17241 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17242 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17243 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017244 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017245
17246 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17247 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017248
17249 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17250 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17251 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17252 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17253 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17254
17255 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17256 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17257 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17258 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17259 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17260
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017261 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17262 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17263
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017264 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17265 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17266 backup connections when going up.
17267
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017268 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17269
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017270 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17271 send or receive data.
17272
17273 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17274 send or receive data.
17275
17276 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17277 with nothing left in the buffers.
17278
17279 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17280
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017281 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017282 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17283
17284 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17285 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17286 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17287 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17288 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17289
17290 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17291 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17292
17293 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17294 server (HTTP only).
17295
17296 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17297
17298 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17299 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17300 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17301
17302 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17303 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17304 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17305
17306 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17307
17308 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17309 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17310
17311 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17312 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17313 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17314
17315 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17316 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017317 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17318 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017319
17320 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17321 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17322 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17323 another server.
17324
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017325 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017326 server.
17327
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017328 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17329 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17330 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17331 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17332
17333 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17334 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17335 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17336 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17337
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017338 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17339 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17340 "use-server" rule).
17341
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17343
17344 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17345 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17346
17347 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17348
17349 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17350 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17351 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17352
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017353 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17354 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017355 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017356 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17357 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017359 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17360
17361 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17362 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17363
17364 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17365
17366 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17367
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017368The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17369was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017370helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17371starvation, attacks, etc...
17372
17373The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17374alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17375easier finding and understanding.
17376
17377 Flags Reason
17378
17379 -- Normal termination.
17380
17381 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17382 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17383 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17384 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17385
17386 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17387 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17388 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17389 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17390 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17391 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017393 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17394 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017395 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017396
17397 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17398 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17399 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17400
17401 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17402 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17403 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17404 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17405 the server takes too long to respond.
17406
17407 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17408 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17409 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17410 long a time to respond.
17411
17412 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17413 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17414 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17415 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017416 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17417 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017418
17419 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17420 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17421 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17422 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17423 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017424 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017425 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17426 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17427 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17428 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17429 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17430 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17431 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17432 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017433 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017434 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17435 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17436 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017437
17438 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17439 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017440 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17441 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17442 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17443 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017445 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17446 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017448 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017449 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17450 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017451 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017452 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17453 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17454
17455 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17456 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17457 503 or 504 here.
17458
17459 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17460 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17461 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17462 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17463 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17464
17465 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17466 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017467 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17469 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17470
17471 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17472 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17473 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17474 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17475 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17476 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17477 between haproxy and the server.
17478
17479 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17480 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17481 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17482 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17483 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17484 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17485 solution is to fix the application.
17486
17487 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17488 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17489 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17490 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17491 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17492 external attacks.
17493
17494 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17495 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017496 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017497 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17498 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17499
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017500 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17501 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17502 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017503 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017504 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017505
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017506 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17507 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17508 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17509 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017510 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17511 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17512 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17513 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17514 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017515
17516 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17517 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17518 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17519 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17520
17521 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17522 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17523 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17524 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17525
17526 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17527 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17528 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17529 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17530
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017531The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17532persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17533important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17534re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17535
17536 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17537
17538 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17539 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17540 set on a GET request.
17541
17542 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17543 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017544 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017545 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17546
17547 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17548 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17549 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17550
17551 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17552 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17553 already got a cookie.
17554
17555 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17556 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17557 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17558 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17559 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17560
17561 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17562 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17563 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17564
17565 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17566 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17567 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17568
17569 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17570 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17571
17572 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17573 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17574 then advertised in the response.
17575
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175778.6. Non-printable characters
17578-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579
17580In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17581consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17582converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17583prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17584being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17585escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17586is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17587'}' when logging headers.
17588
17589Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17590issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17591containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17592
17593Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17594the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17595performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17596
17597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17599---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017600
17601Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17602achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017603section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017604cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17605the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17606the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017607locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017608not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17609user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17610a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17611wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17612
17613 Examples :
17614 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17615 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17616
17617 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17618 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17619
17620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176218.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17622---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623
17624Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17625proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17626the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17627server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17628
17629Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17630response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017631section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632
17633It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017634time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17635appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17637and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17638follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17639request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17640in the logs.
17641
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017642As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17643frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17644an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17645
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017646 Example :
17647 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17648 listen proxy-out
17649 mode http
17650 option httplog
17651 option logasap
17652 log global
17653 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17654
17655 # log the name of the virtual server
17656 capture request header Host len 20
17657
17658 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17659 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17660
17661 # log the beginning of the referrer
17662 capture request header Referer len 20
17663
17664 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17665 capture response header Server len 20
17666
17667 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17668 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17669
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017670 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017671 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17672
17673 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17674 capture response header Via len 20
17675
17676 # log the URL location during a redirection
17677 capture response header Location len 20
17678
17679 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17680 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17681 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17682 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17683 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17684
17685 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17686 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17687 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17688 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017689 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017690
17691 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17692 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17693 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17694 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17695 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017696 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697
17698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176998.9. Examples of logs
17700---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017701
17702These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17703them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17704reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17705
17706 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17707 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17708 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17709
17710 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17711 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17712
17713 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17714 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17715 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17716
17717 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17718 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17719
17720 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17721 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17722 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17723
17724 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017725 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017726 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17727 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17728
17729 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17730 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17731 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17732
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017733 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17734 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17735 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17736 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17737 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17738 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017739
17740 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017741 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017742
17743 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17744 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17745 Nothing was sent to any server.
17746
17747 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17748 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17749
17750 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17751 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017752 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753 send a 408 return code to the client.
17754
17755 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17756 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17757
17758 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17759 5 seconds ("c----").
17760
17761 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17762 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017763 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017764
17765 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017766 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017767 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17768 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17769 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17770 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17771 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017772
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017773
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200177749. Supported filters
17775--------------------
17776
17777Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17778accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17779unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17780
17781See also : "filter"
17782
177839.1. Trace
17784----------
17785
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017786filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017787
17788 Arguments:
17789 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17790 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17791
17792 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17793 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17794 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17795 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017797 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017798 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17799 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17800 amount of the parsed data.
17801
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017802 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017803
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017804This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17805callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17806information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17807filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17808
17809Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17810tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17811a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17812
17813
178149.2. HTTP compression
17815---------------------
17816
17817filter compression
17818
17819The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17820keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017821when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17822fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17823done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17824explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17825filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17826listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17827order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017828
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017829See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17830 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017831
17832
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178339.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17834--------------------------------------------
17835
17836filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17837
17838 Arguments :
17839
17840 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17841 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17842 parsed.
17843
17844 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17845 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17846 part must be placed in its own scope.
17847
17848The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17849external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017850streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017851exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17852also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17853
17854SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17855the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17856
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017857For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017858"doc/SPOE.txt".
17859
17860Important note:
17861 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17862 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17863
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178649.4. Cache
17865----------
17866
17867filter cache <name>
17868
17869 Arguments :
17870
17871 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17872
17873The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17874"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017875cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017876other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17877case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17878is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17879filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017880listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17881order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017882
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017883See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17884 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17885
17886
178879.5. Fcgi-app
17888-------------
17889
17890filter fcg-app <name>
17891
17892 Arguments :
17893
17894 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17895
17896The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17897request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17898reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17899used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17900implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17901used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17902fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17903used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17904order.
17905
17906See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17907 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17908
17909
1791010. FastCGI applications
17911-------------------------
17912
17913HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
17914feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
17915the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
17916FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
17917servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
17918FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
17919backend.
17920
17921HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
17922application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
17923connection.
17924
1792510.1. Setup
17926-----------
17927
1792810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
17929--------------------------
17930
17931fcgi-app <name>
17932 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
17933 document root must be defined.
17934
17935acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
17936 Declare or complete an access list.
17937
17938 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
17939 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
17940 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
17941 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
17942 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
17943
17944docroot <path>
17945 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
17946 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
17947 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
17948
17949index <script-name>
17950 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
17951 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
17952 is an optional setting.
17953
17954 Example :
17955 index index.php
17956
17957log-stderr global
17958log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
17959 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
17960 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
17961
17962 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
17963 default STDERR messages are ignored.
17964
17965pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17966 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
17967 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
17968 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
17969
17970 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
17971 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
17972 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
17973 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
17974
17975 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
17976 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
17977
17978path-info <regex>
17979 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
17980 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
17981 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
17982 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
17983 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
17984
17985 Example :
17986 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
17987
17988option get-values
17989no option get-values
17990 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
17991
17992 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
17993 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
17994
17995 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
17996 application will accept.
17997
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020017998 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
17999 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018000
18001 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18002 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18003 option is disabled.
18004
18005 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18006 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18007 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18008 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18009 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18010 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18011
18012option keep-conn
18013no option keep-conn
18014 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18015 sending a response.
18016
18017 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18018 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18019
18020option max-reqs <reqs>
18021 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18022 accept.
18023
18024 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18025 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18026 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18027 to 1.
18028
18029option mpxs-conns
18030no option mpxs-conns
18031 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18032
18033 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18034 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18035
18036set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18037 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18038 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18039 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18040 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18041
18042 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18043 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18044 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18045
18046 Example :
18047 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18048 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18049
18050 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18051
18052
1805310.1.2. Proxy section
18054---------------------
18055
18056use-fcgi-app <name>
18057 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18058
18059 Arguments :
18060 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18061
18062 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18063 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18064 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18065 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18066 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18067
18068 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18069 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18070 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18071 application are evaluated.
18072
18073
1807410.1.3. Example
18075---------------
18076
18077 frontend front-http
18078 mode http
18079 bind *:80
18080 bind *:
18081
18082 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18083 default_backend back-static
18084
18085 backend back-static
18086 mode http
18087 server www A.B.C.D:80
18088
18089 backend back-dynamic
18090 mode http
18091 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18092 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18093
18094 fcgi-app php-fpm
18095 log-stderr global
18096 option keep-conn
18097
18098 docroot /var/www/my-app
18099 index index.php
18100 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18101
18102
1810310.2. Default parameters
18104------------------------
18105
18106A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18107the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18108scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18109applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18110
18111 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18112 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18113 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18114 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18115 | | |
18116 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18117 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18118 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18119 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18120 | | application. |
18121 | | |
18122 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18123 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18124 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18125 | | |
18126 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18127 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18128 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18129 | | the application's configuration. |
18130 | | |
18131 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18132 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18133 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18134 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18135 | | |
18136 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18137 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18138 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18139 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18140 | | be defined. |
18141 | | |
18142 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18143 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18144 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18145 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18146 | | is not set too. |
18147 | | |
18148 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18149 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18150 | | set. |
18151 | | |
18152 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18153 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18154 | | the request. |
18155 | | |
18156 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18157 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18158 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18159 | | |
18160 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18161 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18162 | | script to process the request. |
18163 | | |
18164 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18165 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18166 | | |
18167 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18168 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18169 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18170 | | |
18171 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18172 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18173 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18174 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18175 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18176 | | |
18177 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18178 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18179 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18180 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18181 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18182 | | side. |
18183 | | |
18184 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18185 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18186 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18187 | | connected to. |
18188 | | |
18189 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18190 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18191 | | |
18192 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18193 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18194 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18195 | | |
18196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18197
18198
1819910.3. Limitations
18200------------------
18201
18202The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18203way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18204during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18205establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18206application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18207or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18208message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18209these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18210and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18211
18212Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18213request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18214requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18215
18216About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18217into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18218fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18219"http-request" ones.
18220
18221Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18222FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18223processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18224must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18225here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018227/*
18228 * Local variables:
18229 * fill-column: 79
18230 * End:
18231 */